Make defvar affect the default binding outside of any let.
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob9f296d9a82e4ace5dae81821846ddc441258611c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
26 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28 #include "lisp.h"
29 #include "blockinput.h"
30 #include "syssignal.h"
32 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
33 if this is not done before the other system files. */
34 #include "xterm.h"
35 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
38 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
39 #ifndef makedev
40 #include <sys/types.h>
41 #endif /* makedev */
43 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45 #include "systime.h"
47 #include <fcntl.h>
48 #include <errno.h>
49 #include <sys/stat.h>
50 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
51 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
53 #include "charset.h"
54 #include "character.h"
55 #include "coding.h"
56 #include "frame.h"
57 #include "dispextern.h"
58 #include "fontset.h"
59 #include "termhooks.h"
60 #include "termopts.h"
61 #include "termchar.h"
62 #include "emacs-icon.h"
63 #include "disptab.h"
64 #include "buffer.h"
65 #include "window.h"
66 #include "keyboard.h"
67 #include "intervals.h"
68 #include "process.h"
69 #include "atimer.h"
70 #include "keymap.h"
71 #include "font.h"
72 #include "xsettings.h"
73 #include "xgselect.h"
74 #include "sysselect.h"
76 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
77 #include <X11/Shell.h>
78 #endif
80 #include <unistd.h>
82 #ifdef USE_GTK
83 #include "gtkutil.h"
84 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
85 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
86 #endif
87 #endif
89 #ifdef USE_LUCID
90 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
91 #endif
93 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
94 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
95 #define HACK_EDITRES
96 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
97 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
99 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
101 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
102 #if defined USE_MOTIF
103 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
104 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
105 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
107 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
108 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
109 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
110 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
111 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
112 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
113 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
114 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
115 #ifndef XtNpickTop
116 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
117 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
118 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
119 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
121 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
123 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
124 #include "widget.h"
125 #ifndef XtNinitialState
126 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
127 #endif
128 #endif
130 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
132 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
133 #include <X11/XKBlib.h>
134 #endif
136 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
137 #ifdef USE_XIM
138 int use_xim = 1;
139 #else
140 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
141 #endif
145 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
146 start. */
148 static bool any_help_event_p;
150 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
151 static Lisp_Object last_window;
153 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
154 use. */
156 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
158 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
159 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
160 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
161 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
163 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
165 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
167 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
169 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
171 static struct {
172 struct frame *f;
173 int eventtype;
174 } pending_event_wait;
176 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
177 /* The application context for Xt use. */
178 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
179 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
181 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
183 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
184 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
186 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
187 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
188 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
190 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
192 /* Mouse movement.
194 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
195 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
196 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
197 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
199 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
201 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
202 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
203 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
204 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
205 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
206 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
207 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
208 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
209 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
210 is off. */
212 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
214 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
215 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
217 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
219 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
220 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
221 an ordinary motion.
223 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
224 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
225 event. */
227 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
229 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
230 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
231 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
232 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
233 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
234 it's somewhat accurate. */
236 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
238 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
240 static Time last_user_time;
242 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
243 events. */
245 static int volatile input_signal_count;
247 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
249 static int x_noop_count;
251 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
253 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
254 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
256 #ifdef USE_GTK
257 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
258 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
260 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
261 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
262 #endif
264 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
265 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
267 enum xembed_info
269 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
272 enum xembed_message
274 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
275 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
276 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
277 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
280 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
281 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
283 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
284 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
285 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
286 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
287 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
290 static bool x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
291 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
292 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
293 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
294 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
295 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
297 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
298 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
299 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
300 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
301 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
302 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
303 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
304 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
305 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
306 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
307 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
308 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
309 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
310 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
311 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
312 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
313 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
314 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
315 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
316 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
317 enum text_cursor_kinds);
319 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
320 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
321 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
322 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
323 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
324 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
325 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
326 enum scroll_bar_part *,
327 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
328 Time *);
329 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
330 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
331 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
332 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
333 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
334 int *, struct input_event *);
335 #ifdef USE_GTK
336 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
337 #endif
338 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
339 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
340 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
341 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
342 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
343 static void x_initialize (void);
346 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
348 static void
349 x_flush (struct frame *f)
351 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
352 connection may be broken. */
353 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
354 return;
356 block_input ();
357 if (f)
359 eassert (FRAME_X_P (f));
360 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
362 else
364 /* Flush all displays and so all frames on them. */
365 struct x_display_info *xdi;
366 for (xdi = x_display_list; xdi; xdi = xdi->next)
367 XFlush (xdi->display);
369 unblock_input ();
373 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
374 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
375 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
376 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
377 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
378 performance. */
380 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
383 /***********************************************************************
384 Debugging
385 ***********************************************************************/
387 #if 0
389 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
390 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
392 struct record
394 char *locus;
395 int type;
398 struct record event_record[100];
400 int event_record_index;
402 void
403 record_event (char *locus, int type)
405 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
406 event_record_index = 0;
408 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
409 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
410 event_record_index++;
413 #endif /* 0 */
417 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
419 struct x_display_info *
420 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
422 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
424 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
425 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
426 return dpyinfo;
428 return 0;
431 static Window
432 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
434 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
435 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
436 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
438 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
440 Window root;
441 Window *children;
442 unsigned int nchildren;
444 win = wi;
445 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
446 XFree (children);
449 return win;
452 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
454 void
455 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
457 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
458 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
459 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
460 double alpha = 1.0;
461 double alpha_min = 1.0;
462 unsigned long opac;
463 Window parent;
465 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
466 alpha = f->alpha[0];
467 else
468 alpha = f->alpha[1];
470 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
471 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
472 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
473 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
475 if (alpha < 0.0)
476 return;
477 else if (alpha > 1.0)
478 alpha = 1.0;
479 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
480 alpha = alpha_min;
482 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
484 x_catch_errors (dpy);
486 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
487 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
488 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
489 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
491 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
492 if (parent != None)
493 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
494 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
495 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
497 /* return unless necessary */
499 unsigned char *data;
500 Atom actual;
501 int rc, format;
502 unsigned long n, left;
504 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
505 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
506 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
507 &data);
509 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
511 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
512 XFree (data);
513 if (value == opac)
515 x_uncatch_errors ();
516 return;
521 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
522 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
523 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
524 x_uncatch_errors ();
528 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
530 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
534 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
536 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
540 /***********************************************************************
541 Starting and ending an update
542 ***********************************************************************/
544 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
545 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
546 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
547 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
548 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
550 static void
551 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
553 /* Nothing to do. */
557 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
558 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
559 position of W. */
561 static void
562 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
564 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
565 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
567 updated_window = w;
568 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
570 block_input ();
572 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
574 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
575 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
577 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
578 highlighting. */
579 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
580 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
583 unblock_input ();
587 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
589 static void
590 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
592 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
593 struct face *face;
595 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
596 if (face)
597 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
598 face->foreground);
600 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
601 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
604 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
606 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
607 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
609 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
610 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
611 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
613 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
614 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
615 here. */
617 static void
618 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
620 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
622 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
624 block_input ();
626 if (cursor_on_p)
627 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
628 output_cursor.vpos,
629 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
631 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
632 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
634 unblock_input ();
637 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
638 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
639 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
641 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
642 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
643 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
646 updated_window = NULL;
650 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
651 update_end. */
653 static void
654 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
656 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
657 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
659 #ifndef XFlush
660 block_input ();
661 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
662 unblock_input ();
663 #endif
667 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
668 complete update has been performed. The global variable
669 updated_window is not available here. */
671 static void
672 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
674 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
675 FRAME_MOUSE_UPDATE (f);
679 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
680 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
681 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
682 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
683 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
684 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
686 static void
687 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
689 struct window *w = updated_window;
690 struct frame *f;
691 int width, height;
693 eassert (w);
695 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
696 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
698 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
699 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
700 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
701 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
702 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
703 overhead is very small. */
704 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
705 && desired_row->full_width_p
706 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
707 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
708 width != 0)
709 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
710 height > 0))
712 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
714 block_input ();
715 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
716 0, y, width, height, False);
717 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
718 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
719 y, width, height, False);
720 unblock_input ();
724 static void
725 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
727 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
728 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
729 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
730 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
731 struct face *face = p->face;
733 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
734 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
736 if (!p->overlay_p)
738 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
740 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
741 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
742 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
743 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
744 if (face->stipple)
745 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
746 else
747 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
749 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
750 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
751 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
752 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
753 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
754 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
755 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
756 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
758 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
760 if (sb_width > 0)
762 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
763 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
764 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
766 if (bx < 0)
768 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
769 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
770 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
771 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
772 bx = bar_area_x;
773 if (bx >= 0)
775 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
777 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
778 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
779 row->y));
780 ny = row->visible_height;
783 else
785 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
787 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
788 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
790 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
791 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
795 #endif
796 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
797 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
799 if (!face->stipple)
800 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
803 if (p->which)
805 char *bits;
806 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
807 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
808 XGCValues gcv;
810 if (p->wd > 8)
811 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
812 else
813 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
815 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
816 by the server. */
817 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
818 (p->cursor_p
819 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
820 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
821 : face->foreground),
822 face->background, depth);
824 if (p->overlay_p)
826 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
827 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
828 bits, p->wd, p->h,
829 1, 0, 1);
830 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
831 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
832 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
833 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
836 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
837 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
838 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
840 if (p->overlay_p)
842 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
843 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
844 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
848 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
853 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
854 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
855 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
856 rarely happens). */
858 static void
859 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
863 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
864 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
866 static void
867 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
872 /***********************************************************************
873 Glyph display
874 ***********************************************************************/
878 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
879 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
880 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
881 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
882 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
883 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
884 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
885 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
886 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
887 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
888 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
889 static bool x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
890 unsigned long *, double, int);
891 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
892 double, int, unsigned long);
893 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
894 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
895 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
898 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
899 int, int, int);
900 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
901 int, int, int, int, int, int,
902 XRectangle *);
903 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
904 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
905 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
907 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
908 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
909 #endif
912 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
913 face. */
915 static void
916 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
918 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
919 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
920 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
921 && !s->cmp)
922 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
923 else
925 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
926 XGCValues xgcv;
927 unsigned long mask;
929 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
930 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
932 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
933 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
934 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
935 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
936 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
937 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
938 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
940 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
941 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
942 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
944 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
945 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
948 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
949 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
950 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
952 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
953 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
954 mask, &xgcv);
955 else
956 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
957 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
959 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
964 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
966 static void
967 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
969 int face_id;
970 struct face *face;
972 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
973 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
974 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
975 if (face == NULL)
976 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
978 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
979 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
980 else
981 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
982 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
983 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
985 if (s->font == s->face->font)
986 s->gc = s->face->gc;
987 else
989 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
990 except for FONT. */
991 XGCValues xgcv;
992 unsigned long mask;
994 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
995 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
996 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
997 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
999 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1000 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1001 mask, &xgcv);
1002 else
1003 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1004 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1006 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1009 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1013 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1014 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1015 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1017 static void
1018 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1020 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1024 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1025 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1026 pattern. */
1028 static void
1029 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1031 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1033 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1035 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1036 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1038 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1040 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1041 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1043 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1045 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1046 s->stippled_p = 0;
1048 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1050 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1051 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1053 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1054 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1056 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1057 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1059 else
1061 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1062 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1065 /* GC must have been set. */
1066 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1070 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1071 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1073 static void
1074 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1076 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1077 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1079 if (n > 0)
1080 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1081 s->num_clips = n;
1085 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1086 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1087 the area of SRC. */
1089 static void
1090 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1092 XRectangle r;
1094 r.x = src->x;
1095 r.width = src->width;
1096 r.y = src->y;
1097 r.height = src->height;
1098 dst->clip[0] = r;
1099 dst->num_clips = 1;
1100 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1104 /* RIF:
1105 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1107 static void
1108 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1110 if (s->cmp == NULL
1111 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1112 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1114 struct font_metrics metrics;
1116 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1118 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1119 struct font *font = s->font;
1120 int i;
1122 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1123 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1124 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1126 else
1128 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1130 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1132 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1133 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1134 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1136 else if (s->cmp)
1138 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1139 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1144 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1146 static void
1147 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1149 XGCValues xgcv;
1150 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1151 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1152 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1153 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1157 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1158 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1159 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1160 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1161 contains the first component of a composition. */
1163 static void
1164 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, bool force_p)
1166 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1167 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1168 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1170 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1172 if (s->stippled_p)
1174 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1175 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1176 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1177 s->y + box_line_width,
1178 s->background_width,
1179 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1180 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1181 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1183 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1184 || s->font_not_found_p
1185 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1186 || force_p)
1188 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1189 s->background_width,
1190 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1191 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1197 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1199 static void
1200 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1202 int i, x;
1204 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1205 of S to the right of that box line. */
1206 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1207 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1208 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1209 else
1210 x = s->x;
1212 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1213 loaded. */
1214 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1216 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1218 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1219 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1220 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1221 s->height - 1);
1222 x += g->pixel_width;
1225 else
1227 struct font *font = s->font;
1228 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1229 int y;
1231 if (font->vertical_centering)
1232 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1234 y = s->ybase - boff;
1235 if (s->for_overlaps
1236 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1237 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1238 else
1239 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1240 if (s->face->overstrike)
1241 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1245 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1247 static void
1248 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1250 int i, j, x;
1251 struct font *font = s->font;
1253 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1254 of S to the right of that box line. */
1255 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1256 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1257 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1258 else
1259 x = s->x;
1261 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1262 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1263 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1264 this composition. */
1266 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1267 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1268 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1270 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1271 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1272 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1274 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1276 int y = s->ybase;
1278 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1279 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1280 space on the left or right. */
1281 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1283 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1284 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1286 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1287 if (s->face->overstrike)
1288 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1291 else
1293 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1294 Lisp_Object glyph;
1295 int y = s->ybase;
1296 int width = 0;
1298 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1300 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1301 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1302 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1303 else
1305 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1307 if (j < i)
1309 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1310 if (s->face->overstrike)
1311 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1312 x += width;
1314 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1315 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1316 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1317 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1318 if (s->face->overstrike)
1319 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1320 x += wadjust;
1321 j = i + 1;
1322 width = 0;
1325 if (j < i)
1327 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1328 if (s->face->overstrike)
1329 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1335 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1337 static void
1338 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1340 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1341 XChar2b char2b[8];
1342 int x, i, j;
1344 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1345 of S to the right of that box line. */
1346 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1347 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1348 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1349 else
1350 x = s->x;
1352 s->char2b = char2b;
1354 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1356 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1357 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1359 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1361 if (len > 0
1362 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1363 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1364 >= 1))
1366 Lisp_Object acronym
1367 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1368 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1369 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1370 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1371 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1372 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1375 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1377 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1378 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1379 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1380 str = buf;
1383 if (str)
1385 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1386 unsigned code;
1388 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1389 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1391 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1392 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1394 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1395 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1396 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1398 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1399 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1400 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1403 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1404 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1405 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1406 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1407 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1408 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1412 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1414 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1416 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1417 cannot be determined. */
1419 static struct frame *
1420 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1422 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1423 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
1424 struct frame *f;
1426 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1428 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1429 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1430 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1431 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1432 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1433 widget = XtParent (widget);
1435 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1436 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1437 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
1439 f = XFRAME (frame);
1440 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
1441 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1442 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo
1443 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1444 return f;
1446 emacs_abort ();
1449 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1450 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1451 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1452 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1453 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1454 Value is true if successful. */
1456 bool
1457 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1458 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1460 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1461 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1464 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1467 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1468 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1470 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1472 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1473 sizeof (Screen *)},
1474 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1475 sizeof (Colormap)}
1479 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1480 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1482 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1485 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1487 DPY is the display we are working on.
1489 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1490 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1491 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1492 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1494 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1495 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1497 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1498 we allocated the color or not.
1500 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1502 static Boolean
1503 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1504 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1505 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1507 Screen *screen;
1508 Colormap cmap;
1509 Pixel pixel;
1510 String color_name;
1511 XColor color;
1513 if (*nargs != 2)
1515 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1516 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1517 "XtToolkitError",
1518 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1519 return False;
1522 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1523 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1524 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1526 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1528 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1529 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1531 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1533 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1534 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1536 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1537 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1539 pixel = color.pixel;
1540 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1542 else
1544 String params[1];
1545 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1547 params[0] = color_name;
1548 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1549 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1550 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1551 params, &nparams);
1552 return False;
1555 if (to->addr != NULL)
1557 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1559 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1560 return False;
1563 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1565 else
1567 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1568 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1571 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1572 return True;
1576 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1577 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1578 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1580 APP is the application context in which we work.
1582 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1583 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1584 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1586 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1588 static void
1589 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1590 Cardinal *nargs)
1592 if (*nargs != 2)
1594 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1595 "XtToolkitError",
1596 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1597 NULL, NULL);
1599 else if (closure != NULL)
1601 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1602 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1603 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1604 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1605 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1610 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1613 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1614 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1615 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1616 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1618 static const XColor *
1619 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1621 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1623 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1625 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1626 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1627 int i;
1629 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1630 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1631 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1633 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1634 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1636 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1637 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1640 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1641 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1645 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1646 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1648 void
1649 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1651 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1653 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1655 int i;
1656 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1658 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1659 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1660 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1661 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1664 else
1665 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1669 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1670 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1672 void
1673 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1675 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1679 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1680 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1681 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1682 allocated. */
1684 static bool
1685 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1687 bool rc;
1689 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1690 if (rc == 0)
1692 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1693 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1694 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1695 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1696 int nearest, i;
1697 int max_color_delta = 255;
1698 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1699 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1700 int ncells;
1701 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1703 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1705 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1706 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1707 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1708 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1710 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1712 nearest = i;
1713 nearest_delta = delta;
1717 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1718 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1719 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1720 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color) != 0;
1722 else
1724 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1725 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1726 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1727 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1728 XColor *cached_color;
1730 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1731 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1732 (cached_color->red != color->red
1733 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1734 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1736 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1737 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1738 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1742 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1743 if (rc)
1744 register_color (color->pixel);
1745 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1747 return rc;
1751 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1752 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1753 Value is true if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1754 allocated. */
1756 bool
1757 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1759 gamma_correct (f, color);
1760 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1764 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1765 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1766 get color reference counts right. */
1768 unsigned long
1769 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1771 XColor color;
1773 color.pixel = pixel;
1774 block_input ();
1775 x_query_color (f, &color);
1776 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1777 unblock_input ();
1778 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1779 register_color (pixel);
1780 #endif
1781 return color.pixel;
1785 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1786 boosted.
1788 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1789 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1790 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1791 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1792 use an additional additive factor.
1794 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1795 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1796 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1799 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1800 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1801 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1802 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1803 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1804 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1806 static bool
1807 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1809 XColor color, new;
1810 long bright;
1811 bool success_p;
1813 /* Get RGB color values. */
1814 color.pixel = *pixel;
1815 x_query_color (f, &color);
1817 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1818 eassert (factor >= 0);
1819 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1820 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1821 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1823 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1824 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1826 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1827 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1828 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1829 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1830 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1832 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1833 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1834 /* The additive adjustment. */
1835 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1837 if (factor < 1)
1839 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1840 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1841 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1843 else
1845 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1846 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1847 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1851 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1852 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1853 if (success_p)
1855 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1857 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1858 delta to the RGB values. */
1859 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1861 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1862 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1863 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1864 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1866 else
1867 success_p = 1;
1868 *pixel = new.pixel;
1871 return success_p;
1875 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1876 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1877 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1878 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1879 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1880 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1882 static void
1883 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1885 XGCValues xgcv;
1886 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1887 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1888 unsigned long pixel;
1889 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1890 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1891 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1892 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1894 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1895 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1897 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1898 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1899 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1900 if (relief->gc
1901 && relief->allocated_p)
1903 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1904 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1907 /* Allocate new color. */
1908 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1909 pixel = background;
1910 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1911 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1913 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1914 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1917 if (relief->gc == 0)
1919 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1920 mask |= GCStipple;
1921 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1923 else
1924 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1928 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1930 static void
1931 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1933 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1934 unsigned long color;
1936 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1937 color = s->face->box_color;
1938 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1939 && s->img->pixmap
1940 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1941 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1942 else
1944 XGCValues xgcv;
1946 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1947 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1948 color = xgcv.background;
1951 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1952 || color != di->relief_background)
1954 di->relief_background = color;
1955 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1956 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1957 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1958 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1963 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1964 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1965 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1966 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1967 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1968 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1969 when drawing. */
1971 static void
1972 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1973 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1974 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1975 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1977 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1978 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1979 int i;
1980 GC gc;
1982 if (raised_p)
1983 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
1984 else
1985 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
1986 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
1988 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
1989 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
1990 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
1991 corner pixels. */
1993 /* Top. */
1994 if (top_p)
1996 if (width == 1)
1997 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
1998 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
1999 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2001 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2002 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2003 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2004 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2007 /* Left. */
2008 if (left_p)
2010 if (width == 1)
2011 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2013 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2014 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2016 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2017 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2018 left_x + i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2019 left_x + i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2022 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2023 if (raised_p)
2024 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2025 else
2026 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2027 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2029 if (width > 1)
2031 /* Outermost top line. */
2032 if (top_p)
2033 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2034 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2035 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2037 /* Outermost left line. */
2038 if (left_p)
2039 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2042 /* Bottom. */
2043 if (bot_p)
2045 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2046 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2047 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2048 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2049 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2050 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2051 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2054 /* Right. */
2055 if (right_p)
2057 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2058 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2059 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2060 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2061 right_x - i, top_y + (i + 1) * top_p,
2062 right_x - i, bottom_y + 1 - (i + 1) * bot_p);
2065 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2069 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2070 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2071 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2072 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2073 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2074 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2076 static void
2077 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2078 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2079 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2081 XGCValues xgcv;
2083 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2084 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2085 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2087 /* Top. */
2088 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2089 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2091 /* Left. */
2092 if (left_p)
2093 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2094 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2096 /* Bottom. */
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2100 /* Right. */
2101 if (right_p)
2102 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2103 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2105 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2106 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2110 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2112 static void
2113 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2115 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2116 int left_p, right_p;
2117 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2118 XRectangle clip_rect;
2120 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2121 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2122 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2124 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2125 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2126 ? s->first_glyph
2127 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2129 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2130 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2131 left_x = s->x;
2132 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2133 ? last_x - 1
2134 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2135 top_y = s->y;
2136 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2138 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2139 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2140 && (s->prev == NULL
2141 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2142 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2143 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2144 && (s->next == NULL
2145 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2147 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2149 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2150 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2151 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2152 else
2154 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2155 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2156 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2161 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2163 static void
2164 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2166 int x = s->x;
2167 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2169 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2170 right of that line. */
2171 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2172 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2173 && s->slice.x == 0)
2174 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2176 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2177 by that margin. */
2178 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2179 x += s->img->hmargin;
2180 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2181 y += s->img->vmargin;
2183 if (s->img->pixmap)
2185 if (s->img->mask)
2187 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2188 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2189 trust on the shape extension to be available
2190 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2191 manually. */
2192 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2193 | GCFunction);
2194 XGCValues xgcv;
2195 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2197 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2198 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2199 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2200 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2201 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2203 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2204 image_rect.x = x;
2205 image_rect.y = y;
2206 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2207 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2208 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2209 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2210 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2211 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2213 else
2215 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2217 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2218 image_rect.x = x;
2219 image_rect.y = y;
2220 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2221 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2222 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2223 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2224 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2225 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2227 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2228 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2229 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2230 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2231 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2232 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2233 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2235 int relief = eabs (s->img->relief);
2236 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2237 x - relief, y - relief,
2238 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2239 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2243 else
2244 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2245 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2246 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2250 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2252 static void
2253 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2255 int x1, y1, thick, raised_p, top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p;
2256 XRectangle r;
2257 int x = s->x;
2258 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2260 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2261 right of that line. */
2262 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2263 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2264 && s->slice.x == 0)
2265 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2267 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2268 by that margin. */
2269 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2270 x += s->img->hmargin;
2271 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2272 y += s->img->vmargin;
2274 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2275 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2277 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2278 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2280 else
2282 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2283 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2286 x1 = x + s->slice.width - 1;
2287 y1 = y + s->slice.height - 1;
2288 top_p = bot_p = left_p = right_p = 0;
2290 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2291 x -= thick, left_p = 1;
2292 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2293 y -= thick, top_p = 1;
2294 if (s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width)
2295 x1 += thick, right_p = 1;
2296 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height)
2297 y1 += thick, bot_p = 1;
2299 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2300 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2301 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x, y, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2302 top_p, bot_p, left_p, right_p, &r);
2306 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2308 static void
2309 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2311 int x = 0;
2312 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2314 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2315 right of that line. */
2316 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2317 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2318 && s->slice.x == 0)
2319 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2321 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2322 by that margin. */
2323 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2324 x += s->img->hmargin;
2325 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2326 y += s->img->vmargin;
2328 if (s->img->pixmap)
2330 if (s->img->mask)
2332 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2333 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2334 trust on the shape extension to be available
2335 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2336 manually. */
2337 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2338 | GCFunction);
2339 XGCValues xgcv;
2341 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2342 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2343 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2344 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2345 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2347 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2348 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2349 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2350 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2352 else
2354 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2355 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2356 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2358 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2359 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2360 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2361 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2362 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2363 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2364 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2366 int r = eabs (s->img->relief);
2367 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2368 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2369 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2373 else
2374 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2375 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2376 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2380 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2381 give the rectangle to draw. */
2383 static void
2384 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2386 if (s->stippled_p)
2388 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2389 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2390 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2391 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2393 else
2394 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2398 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2400 s->y
2401 s->x +-------------------------
2402 | s->face->box
2404 | +-------------------------
2405 | | s->img->margin
2407 | | +-------------------
2408 | | | the image
2412 static void
2413 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2415 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2416 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2417 int height;
2418 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2420 height = s->height;
2421 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2422 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2423 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2424 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2426 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2427 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2428 flickering. */
2429 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2430 if (height > s->slice.height
2431 || s->img->hmargin
2432 || s->img->vmargin
2433 || s->img->mask
2434 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2435 || s->width != s->background_width)
2437 if (s->img->mask)
2439 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2440 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2441 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2442 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2443 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2445 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2446 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2447 s->background_width,
2448 s->height, depth);
2450 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2451 pixmap. */
2452 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2454 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2455 if (s->stippled_p)
2457 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2458 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2459 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2460 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2461 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2462 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2463 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2465 else
2467 XGCValues xgcv;
2468 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2469 &xgcv);
2470 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2471 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2472 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2473 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2476 else
2478 int x = s->x;
2479 int y = s->y;
2481 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2482 && s->slice.x == 0)
2483 x += box_line_hwidth;
2485 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2486 y += box_line_vwidth;
2488 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2491 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2494 /* Draw the foreground. */
2495 if (pixmap != None)
2497 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2498 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2499 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2500 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2501 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2503 else
2504 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2506 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2507 if (s->img->relief
2508 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2509 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2510 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2514 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2516 static void
2517 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2519 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2521 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2522 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2524 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2525 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2526 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2527 int x = s->x;
2529 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2531 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2533 if (x < left_x)
2535 background_width -= left_x - x;
2536 x = left_x;
2539 else
2541 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2542 stretch glyph. */
2543 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2545 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2546 background_width -= x - right_x;
2547 x += background_width;
2549 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2550 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2551 x -= width;
2553 /* Draw cursor. */
2554 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2556 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2557 if (width < background_width)
2559 int y = s->y;
2560 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2561 XRectangle r;
2562 GC gc;
2564 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2565 x += width;
2566 else
2567 x = s->x;
2568 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2569 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2571 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2572 gc = s->gc;
2574 else
2575 gc = s->face->gc;
2577 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2578 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2580 if (s->face->stipple)
2582 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2583 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2584 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2585 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2587 else
2589 XGCValues xgcv;
2590 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2591 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2592 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2593 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2597 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2599 int background_width = s->background_width;
2600 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2602 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2603 except for header line and mode line. */
2604 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2606 background_width -= left_x - x;
2607 x = left_x;
2609 if (background_width > 0)
2610 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2613 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2617 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2619 x0 wave_length = 2
2621 y0 * * * * *
2622 |* * * * * * * * *
2623 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2627 static void
2628 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2630 int wave_height = 3, wave_length = 2;
2631 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2632 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2634 dx = wave_length;
2635 dy = wave_height - 1;
2636 x0 = s->x;
2637 y0 = s->ybase - wave_height + 3;
2638 width = s->width;
2639 xmax = x0 + width;
2641 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2643 wave_clip.x = x0;
2644 wave_clip.y = y0;
2645 wave_clip.width = width;
2646 wave_clip.height = wave_height;
2647 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2649 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2650 return;
2652 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2654 /* Draw the waves */
2656 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2657 x2 = x1 + dx;
2658 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2659 y1 = y2 = y0;
2661 if (odd)
2662 y1 += dy;
2663 else
2664 y2 += dy;
2666 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2667 emacs_abort ();
2669 while (x1 <= xmax)
2671 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2672 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2673 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2674 odd = !odd;
2677 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2678 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2682 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2684 static void
2685 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2687 bool relief_drawn_p = 0;
2689 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2690 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2691 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2692 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2694 int width;
2695 struct glyph_string *next;
2697 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2698 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2699 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2700 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2702 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2703 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2704 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2705 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2706 else
2707 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2708 next->num_clips = 0;
2712 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2713 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2715 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2716 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2717 if (!s->for_overlaps
2718 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2719 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2720 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2723 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2724 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2725 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2726 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2727 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2729 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2730 && !s->clip_tail
2731 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2732 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2733 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2734 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2735 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2736 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2737 else
2738 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2740 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2742 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2743 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2744 break;
2746 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2747 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2748 break;
2750 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2751 if (s->for_overlaps)
2752 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2753 else
2754 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2755 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2756 break;
2758 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2759 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2760 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2761 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2762 else
2763 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2764 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2765 break;
2767 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2768 if (s->for_overlaps)
2769 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2770 else
2771 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2772 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2773 break;
2775 default:
2776 emacs_abort ();
2779 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2781 /* Draw underline. */
2782 if (s->face->underline_p)
2784 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2786 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2787 x_draw_underwave (s);
2788 else
2790 XGCValues xgcv;
2791 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2792 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2793 x_draw_underwave (s);
2794 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2797 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2799 unsigned long thickness, position;
2800 int y;
2802 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p
2803 && s->prev->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2805 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2806 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2807 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2809 else
2811 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2812 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2813 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2814 else
2815 thickness = 1;
2816 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2817 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2818 else
2820 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2821 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2822 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2823 specs, and its default is
2825 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2826 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2828 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2829 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2830 position = s->font->underline_position;
2831 else if (s->font)
2832 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2833 else
2834 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2836 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2838 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2839 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2840 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2841 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2842 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2843 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2844 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2845 s->underline_position = position;
2846 y = s->ybase + position;
2847 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2848 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2849 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2850 else
2852 XGCValues xgcv;
2853 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2854 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2855 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2856 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2857 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2861 /* Draw overline. */
2862 if (s->face->overline_p)
2864 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2866 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2867 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2868 s->width, h);
2869 else
2871 XGCValues xgcv;
2872 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2873 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2874 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2875 s->width, h);
2876 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2880 /* Draw strike-through. */
2881 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2883 unsigned long h = 1;
2884 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2886 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2887 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2888 s->width, h);
2889 else
2891 XGCValues xgcv;
2892 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2893 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2894 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2895 s->width, h);
2896 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2900 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2901 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2902 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2904 if (s->prev)
2906 struct glyph_string *prev;
2908 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2909 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2910 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2912 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2913 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2914 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2916 prev->hl = s->hl;
2917 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2918 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2919 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2920 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2921 else
2922 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2923 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2924 prev->hl = save;
2925 prev->num_clips = 0;
2929 if (s->next)
2931 struct glyph_string *next;
2933 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2934 if (next->hl != s->hl
2935 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2937 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2938 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2939 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2941 next->hl = s->hl;
2942 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2943 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2944 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2945 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2946 else
2947 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2948 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2949 next->hl = save;
2950 next->num_clips = 0;
2951 next->clip_head = s->next;
2956 /* Reset clipping. */
2957 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2958 s->num_clips = 0;
2961 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2963 static void
2964 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2966 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2967 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2968 x, y, width, height,
2969 x + shift_by, y);
2972 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2973 for X frames. */
2975 static void
2976 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
2978 emacs_abort ();
2982 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2983 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2985 void
2986 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
2988 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2989 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2993 /* Clear an entire frame. */
2995 static void
2996 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
2998 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2999 longer visible. */
3000 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3001 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3002 output_cursor.x = -1;
3004 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3005 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3006 block_input ();
3008 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3010 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3011 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3012 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3014 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3015 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3016 redisplay, do it here. */
3017 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3018 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3019 #endif
3021 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3023 unblock_input ();
3028 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3030 static void
3031 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3033 block_input ();
3036 #ifdef USE_GTK
3037 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3038 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3039 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3040 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3041 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3042 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3043 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3044 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3045 do { \
3046 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3047 cairo_fill (cr); \
3049 while (0)
3050 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3051 GdkGCValues vals;
3052 GdkGC *gc;
3053 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3054 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3055 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3056 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3057 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3058 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3059 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3060 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3061 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3062 GC gc;
3064 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3065 pixels into background pixels. */
3067 XGCValues values;
3069 values.function = GXxor;
3070 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3071 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3073 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3074 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3076 #endif
3078 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3079 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3080 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3081 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3082 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3083 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3084 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3086 int width;
3088 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3089 edge it is next to. */
3090 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3092 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3093 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3094 break;
3096 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3097 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3098 break;
3100 default:
3101 break;
3104 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3106 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3107 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3109 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3110 flash_left,
3111 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3112 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3113 width, flash_height);
3114 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3115 flash_left,
3116 (height - flash_height
3117 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3118 width, flash_height);
3121 else
3122 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3123 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3124 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3125 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3127 x_flush (f);
3130 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3131 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3133 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3134 available. */
3135 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3137 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3138 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3140 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3141 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3142 break;
3144 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3145 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3147 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3148 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3152 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3153 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3155 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3156 flash_left,
3157 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3158 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3159 width, flash_height);
3160 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3161 flash_left,
3162 (height - flash_height
3163 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3164 width, flash_height);
3166 else
3167 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3168 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3169 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3170 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3172 #ifdef USE_GTK
3173 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3174 cairo_destroy (cr);
3175 #else
3176 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3177 #endif
3178 #undef XFillRectangle
3179 #else
3180 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3181 #endif
3182 x_flush (f);
3186 unblock_input ();
3190 static void
3191 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3193 block_input ();
3194 if (invisible)
3196 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3197 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3198 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3200 else
3201 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3202 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3203 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3204 unblock_input ();
3208 /* Make audible bell. */
3210 static void
3211 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3213 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3215 if (visible_bell)
3216 XTflash (f);
3217 else
3219 block_input ();
3220 #ifdef HAVE_XKB
3221 XkbBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, 0, None);
3222 #else
3223 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3224 #endif
3225 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3226 unblock_input ();
3232 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3233 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3234 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3235 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3237 static void
3238 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3240 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3245 /***********************************************************************
3246 Line Dance
3247 ***********************************************************************/
3249 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3250 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3252 static void
3253 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3255 emacs_abort ();
3259 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3261 static void
3262 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3264 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3265 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3267 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3268 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3269 fringe of W. */
3270 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3272 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3273 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3274 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3275 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3276 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3277 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3278 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3279 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3281 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3283 if (sb_width > 0)
3285 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3286 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3287 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3289 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3291 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3292 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3294 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3295 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3298 #endif
3300 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3301 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3302 bottom_y = y + height;
3304 if (to_y < from_y)
3306 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3307 line at the bottom. */
3308 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3309 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3310 else
3311 height = run->height;
3313 else
3315 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3316 at the bottom. */
3317 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3318 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3319 else
3320 height = run->height;
3323 block_input ();
3325 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3326 updated_window = w;
3327 x_clear_cursor (w);
3329 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3330 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3331 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3332 x, from_y,
3333 width, height,
3334 x, to_y);
3336 unblock_input ();
3341 /***********************************************************************
3342 Exposure Events
3343 ***********************************************************************/
3346 static void
3347 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3349 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3350 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3351 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3352 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3353 block_input ();
3354 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3355 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3356 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3357 because of this (bug#9310). */
3358 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3359 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3360 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3361 x_uncatch_errors ();
3362 unblock_input ();
3363 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3364 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3367 static void
3368 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3370 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3371 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3372 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3373 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3374 block_input ();
3375 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3376 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3377 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3378 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3379 x_uncatch_errors ();
3380 unblock_input ();
3381 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3382 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3385 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3386 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3387 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3388 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3389 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3391 static void
3392 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3394 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3396 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3398 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3399 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3400 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3402 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3403 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3405 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3406 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3407 else
3408 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3411 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3414 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3415 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3416 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3418 static void
3419 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3421 if (type == FocusIn)
3423 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3425 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3426 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3428 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3429 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3430 /* When run as a daemon, Vterminal_frame is always NIL. */
3431 bufp->arg = (((NILP (Vterminal_frame) || EQ (Fdaemonp (), Qt))
3432 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3433 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3434 ? Qt : Qnil);
3435 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3436 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3439 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3441 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3442 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3443 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3444 #endif
3446 else if (type == FocusOut)
3448 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3450 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3452 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3453 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3455 bufp->kind = FOCUS_OUT_EVENT;
3456 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3459 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3460 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3461 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3462 #endif
3463 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3464 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3468 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3469 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3471 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3473 static void
3474 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3476 struct frame *frame;
3478 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3479 if (! frame)
3480 return;
3482 switch (event->type)
3484 case EnterNotify:
3485 case LeaveNotify:
3487 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3488 int focus_state
3489 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3491 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3492 && event->xcrossing.focus
3493 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3494 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3495 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3496 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3498 break;
3500 case FocusIn:
3501 case FocusOut:
3502 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3503 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3504 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3505 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3506 break;
3508 case ClientMessage:
3509 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3511 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3512 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3513 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3515 break;
3520 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3521 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3523 void
3524 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3526 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3528 #endif
3530 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3531 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3532 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3534 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3535 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3536 the appropriate X display info. */
3538 static void
3539 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3541 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3544 static void
3545 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3547 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3549 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3551 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3552 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3553 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3554 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3555 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3557 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3558 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3561 else
3562 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3564 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3566 if (old_highlight)
3567 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3568 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3569 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3575 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3577 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3578 static void
3579 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3581 int min_code, max_code;
3582 KeySym *syms;
3583 int syms_per_code;
3584 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3586 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3587 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3588 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3589 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3590 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3592 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3594 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3595 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3596 &syms_per_code);
3597 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3599 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3600 Alt keysyms are on. */
3602 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3603 int found_alt_or_meta;
3605 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3607 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3608 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3610 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3612 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3613 if (code == 0)
3614 continue;
3616 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3618 int code_col;
3620 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3622 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3624 switch (sym)
3626 case XK_Meta_L:
3627 case XK_Meta_R:
3628 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3629 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3630 break;
3632 case XK_Alt_L:
3633 case XK_Alt_R:
3634 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3635 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3636 break;
3638 case XK_Hyper_L:
3639 case XK_Hyper_R:
3640 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3641 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3642 code_col = syms_per_code;
3643 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3644 break;
3646 case XK_Super_L:
3647 case XK_Super_R:
3648 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3649 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3650 code_col = syms_per_code;
3651 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3652 break;
3654 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3655 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3656 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3657 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3658 code_col = syms_per_code;
3659 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3660 break;
3668 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3669 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3671 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3672 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3675 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3676 make them just meta, not alt. */
3677 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3679 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3682 XFree (syms);
3683 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3686 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3687 Emacs uses. */
3690 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3692 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3693 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3694 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3695 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3696 Lisp_Object tem;
3698 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3699 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3700 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3701 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3702 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3703 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3704 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3705 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3707 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3708 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3709 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3710 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3711 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3712 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3715 static int
3716 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3718 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3719 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3720 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3721 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3723 Lisp_Object tem;
3725 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3726 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3727 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3728 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3729 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3730 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3731 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3732 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3735 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3736 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3737 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3738 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3739 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3740 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3743 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3745 char *
3746 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3748 char *value;
3750 block_input ();
3751 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3752 unblock_input ();
3754 return value;
3759 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3761 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3763 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3764 the mouse. */
3766 static Lisp_Object
3767 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3769 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3770 otherwise. */
3771 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3772 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3773 result->timestamp = event->time;
3774 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3775 event->state)
3776 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3777 ? up_modifier
3778 : down_modifier));
3780 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3781 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3782 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3783 result->arg = Qnil;
3784 return Qnil;
3788 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3789 The input handler calls this.
3791 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3792 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3793 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3794 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3796 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3797 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3799 static int
3800 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3802 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3803 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3804 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3806 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3807 return 0;
3809 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3811 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3812 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3813 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3814 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3815 return 1;
3819 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3820 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3821 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3822 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3823 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3824 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3826 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3827 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3828 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3829 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3830 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3831 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3832 return 1;
3835 return 0;
3839 /************************************************************************
3840 Mouse Face
3841 ************************************************************************/
3843 static void
3844 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3846 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3847 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3848 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3849 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3850 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3855 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3856 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3858 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3859 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3860 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3861 position on the scroll bar.
3863 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3864 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3865 the mouse is over.
3867 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3868 was at this position.
3870 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3872 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3873 movement. */
3875 static void
3876 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3877 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3878 Time *timestamp)
3880 FRAME_PTR f1;
3882 block_input ();
3884 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3885 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3886 else
3888 Window root;
3889 int root_x, root_y;
3891 Window dummy_window;
3892 int dummy;
3894 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3896 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3897 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3898 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3899 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3900 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3902 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3904 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3905 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3906 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3908 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3909 &root,
3911 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3912 a different screen. */
3913 &dummy_window,
3915 /* The position on that root window. */
3916 &root_x, &root_y,
3918 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3919 &dummy, &dummy,
3921 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3922 we don't care. */
3923 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3925 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3926 containing the pointer. */
3928 Window win, child;
3929 int win_x, win_y;
3930 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3932 win = root;
3934 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3935 structure is changing at the same time this function
3936 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3938 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3940 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3941 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3943 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3944 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3945 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3947 /* From-window, to-window. */
3948 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3950 /* From-position, to-position. */
3951 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3953 /* Child of win. */
3954 &child);
3955 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3957 else
3959 while (1)
3961 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3963 /* From-window, to-window. */
3964 root, win,
3966 /* From-position, to-position. */
3967 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3969 /* Child of win. */
3970 &child);
3972 if (child == None || child == win)
3973 break;
3974 #ifdef USE_GTK
3975 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3976 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3977 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3978 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3979 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
3980 break;
3981 #endif
3982 win = child;
3983 parent_x = win_x;
3984 parent_y = win_y;
3987 /* Now we know that:
3988 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3989 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3990 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3991 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3992 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3993 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3994 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3995 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3996 never use them in that case.) */
3998 #ifdef USE_GTK
3999 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4000 want the edit window. */
4001 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4002 #else
4003 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4004 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4005 #endif
4007 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4008 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4009 on the frame. */
4010 if (f1 != NULL
4011 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4012 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4013 f1 = NULL;
4014 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4017 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4018 f1 = 0;
4020 x_uncatch_errors ();
4022 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4023 if (! f1)
4025 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4027 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4029 if (bar)
4031 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4032 win_x = parent_x;
4033 win_y = parent_y;
4037 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4038 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4040 if (f1)
4042 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4043 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4044 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4045 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4046 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4047 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4048 the frame are divided into. */
4050 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4051 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4053 *bar_window = Qnil;
4054 *part = 0;
4055 *fp = f1;
4056 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4057 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4058 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4063 unblock_input ();
4068 /***********************************************************************
4069 Scroll bars
4070 ***********************************************************************/
4072 /* Scroll bar support. */
4074 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4075 manages it.
4076 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4077 bits. */
4079 static struct scroll_bar *
4080 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4082 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4084 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4085 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4086 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4088 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4090 Lisp_Object bar, condemned;
4092 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4093 continue;
4095 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4096 right window ID. */
4097 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4098 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4099 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4100 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4101 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4102 condemned = Qnil,
4103 ! NILP (bar));
4104 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4105 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4106 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4107 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4110 return NULL;
4114 #if defined USE_LUCID
4116 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4117 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4119 static Widget
4120 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4122 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
4124 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
4125 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4127 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4129 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4130 return menu_bar;
4132 return NULL;
4135 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4138 /************************************************************************
4139 Toolkit scroll bars
4140 ************************************************************************/
4142 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4144 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4145 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4146 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4147 struct scroll_bar *);
4148 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4149 int, int, int);
4152 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4153 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4155 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4157 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4159 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4161 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4162 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4164 #ifndef USE_GTK
4165 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4167 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4169 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4171 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4172 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4173 to avoid jerkiness. */
4175 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4177 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4178 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4179 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4180 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4182 static void
4183 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4184 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4186 int scroll_bar_p;
4187 const char *end_action;
4189 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4190 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4191 end_action = "Release";
4192 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4193 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4194 end_action = "EndScroll";
4195 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4197 if (scroll_bar_p
4198 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4199 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4201 struct window *w;
4203 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4204 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4205 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4207 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4209 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4210 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4211 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4213 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4214 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4216 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4217 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4220 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4222 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4223 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4225 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4226 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4229 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4230 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4231 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4232 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4234 static void
4235 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4237 XEvent event;
4238 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4239 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4240 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4241 ptrdiff_t i;
4243 block_input ();
4245 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4246 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4247 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4248 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4249 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4250 ev->format = 32;
4252 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4253 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4254 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4255 into that array in the event. */
4256 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4257 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4258 break;
4260 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4262 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4263 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4264 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4265 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4266 scroll_bar_windows =
4267 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4268 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4269 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4270 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4273 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4274 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4275 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4276 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4277 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4278 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4280 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4281 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4282 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4283 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4284 #endif
4286 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4287 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4288 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4289 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4290 unblock_input ();
4294 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4295 in *IEVENT. */
4297 static void
4298 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4300 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4301 Lisp_Object window;
4302 struct window *w;
4304 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4305 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4307 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4309 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4310 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4311 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4312 #ifdef USE_GTK
4313 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4314 #else
4315 ievent->timestamp =
4316 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4317 #endif
4318 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4319 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4320 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4321 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4322 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4326 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4328 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4330 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4333 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4334 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4335 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4337 static void
4338 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4340 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4341 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4342 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4344 switch (cs->reason)
4346 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4347 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4348 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4349 break;
4351 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4352 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4353 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4354 break;
4356 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4357 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4358 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4359 break;
4361 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4362 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4363 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4364 break;
4366 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4367 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4368 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4369 break;
4371 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4372 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4373 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4374 break;
4376 case XmCR_DRAG:
4378 int slider_size;
4380 /* Get the slider size. */
4381 block_input ();
4382 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4383 unblock_input ();
4385 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4386 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4387 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4388 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4390 break;
4392 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4393 break;
4396 if (part >= 0)
4398 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4399 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4400 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4404 #elif defined USE_GTK
4406 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4407 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4409 static gboolean
4410 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4411 GtkScrollType scroll,
4412 gdouble value,
4413 gpointer user_data)
4415 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4416 gdouble position;
4417 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4418 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4419 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4421 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4422 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4425 switch (scroll)
4427 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4428 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4429 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4430 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4432 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4433 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4434 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4435 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4436 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4438 break;
4439 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4440 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4441 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4442 break;
4443 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4444 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4445 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4446 break;
4447 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4448 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4449 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4450 break;
4451 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4452 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4453 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4454 break;
4457 if (part >= 0)
4459 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4460 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4461 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4464 return FALSE;
4467 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4469 static gboolean
4470 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4471 GdkEventButton *event,
4472 gpointer user_data)
4474 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4475 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4476 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4478 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4479 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4480 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4483 return FALSE;
4487 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4489 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4490 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4491 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4492 the thumb is. */
4494 static void
4495 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4497 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4498 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4499 float shown;
4500 int whole, portion, height;
4501 int part;
4503 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4504 block_input ();
4505 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4506 unblock_input ();
4508 whole = 10000000;
4509 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4511 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4512 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4513 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4514 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4515 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4516 bottom). */
4517 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4518 else
4519 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4521 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4522 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4523 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4524 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4528 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4529 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4530 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4531 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4532 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4533 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4534 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4536 static void
4537 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4539 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4540 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4541 int position = (long) call_data;
4542 Dimension height;
4543 int part;
4545 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4546 block_input ();
4547 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4548 unblock_input ();
4550 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4551 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4553 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4554 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4555 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4556 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4557 else
4558 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4560 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4561 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4562 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4563 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4566 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4568 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4570 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4571 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4573 #ifdef USE_GTK
4574 static void
4575 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4577 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4579 block_input ();
4580 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4581 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4582 scroll_bar_name);
4583 unblock_input ();
4586 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4588 static void
4589 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4591 Window xwindow;
4592 Widget widget;
4593 Arg av[20];
4594 int ac = 0;
4595 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4596 unsigned long pixel;
4598 block_input ();
4600 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4601 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4602 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4603 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4604 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4605 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4606 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4607 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4608 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4610 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4611 if (pixel != -1)
4613 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4614 ++ac;
4617 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4618 if (pixel != -1)
4620 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4621 ++ac;
4624 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4625 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4627 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4628 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4629 (XtPointer) bar);
4630 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4631 (XtPointer) bar);
4632 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4633 (XtPointer) bar);
4634 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4635 (XtPointer) bar);
4636 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4637 (XtPointer) bar);
4638 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4639 (XtPointer) bar);
4640 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4641 (XtPointer) bar);
4643 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4644 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4646 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4647 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4648 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4649 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4651 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4653 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4654 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4655 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4656 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4657 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4658 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4659 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4660 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4662 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4663 if (pixel != -1)
4665 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4666 ++ac;
4669 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4670 if (pixel != -1)
4672 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4673 ++ac;
4676 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4678 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4679 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4681 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4682 if (pixel != -1)
4684 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4685 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4686 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4687 pixel = -1;
4688 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4691 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4693 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4694 if (pixel != -1)
4696 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4697 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4698 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4699 pixel = -1;
4700 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4704 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4705 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4706 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4707 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4708 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4709 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4710 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4711 colors itself. */
4713 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4714 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4715 ++ac;
4717 else
4718 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4719 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4720 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4722 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4723 the shadows. */
4724 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4725 ++ac;
4727 /* Specify the colors. */
4728 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4729 if (pixel != -1)
4731 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4732 ++ac;
4734 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4735 if (pixel != -1)
4737 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4738 ++ac;
4741 #endif
4743 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4744 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4747 char const *initial = "";
4748 char const *val = initial;
4749 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4750 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4751 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4752 #endif
4753 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4754 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4755 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4756 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4757 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4758 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4762 /* Define callbacks. */
4763 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4764 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4765 (XtPointer) bar);
4767 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4768 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4770 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4772 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4773 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4774 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4775 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4777 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4778 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4779 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4780 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4782 unblock_input ();
4784 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4787 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4788 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4790 #ifdef USE_GTK
4791 static void
4792 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4794 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4797 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4798 static void
4799 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4800 int whole)
4802 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4803 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4804 float top, shown;
4806 block_input ();
4808 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4810 if (scroll_bar_adjust_thumb_portion_p)
4812 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4813 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4814 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4815 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4816 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4817 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4818 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4819 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4820 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4821 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4822 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4823 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4824 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4825 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4826 whole += portion;
4829 if (whole <= 0)
4830 top = 0, shown = 1;
4831 else
4833 top = (float) position / whole;
4834 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4837 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4839 int size, value;
4841 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4842 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4843 value. */
4844 size = clip_to_bounds (1, shown * XM_SB_MAX, XM_SB_MAX);
4846 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4847 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4848 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4850 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4852 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4854 if (whole == 0)
4855 top = 0, shown = 1;
4856 else
4858 top = (float) position / whole;
4859 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4863 float old_top, old_shown;
4864 Dimension height;
4865 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4866 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4867 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4868 XtNheight, &height,
4869 NULL);
4871 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4872 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4873 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4874 else
4875 top = old_top;
4876 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4877 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4879 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4880 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4881 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4882 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4884 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4885 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4886 else
4888 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4889 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4890 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4892 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4896 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4898 unblock_input ();
4900 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4902 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4906 /************************************************************************
4907 Scroll bars, general
4908 ************************************************************************/
4910 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4911 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4912 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4913 scroll bar. */
4915 static struct scroll_bar *
4916 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4918 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4919 struct scroll_bar *bar
4920 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4921 Lisp_Object barobj;
4923 block_input ();
4925 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4926 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4927 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4929 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4930 unsigned long mask;
4931 Window window;
4933 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4934 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4935 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4937 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4938 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4939 | ExposureMask);
4940 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4942 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4944 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4945 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4946 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4947 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4948 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4949 left, top, width,
4950 window_box_height (w), False);
4952 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4953 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4954 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4955 top,
4956 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4957 height,
4958 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4960 CopyFromParent,
4961 CopyFromParent,
4962 CopyFromParent,
4963 /* Attributes. */
4964 mask, &a);
4965 bar->x_window = window;
4967 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4969 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4970 bar->top = top;
4971 bar->left = left;
4972 bar->width = width;
4973 bar->height = height;
4974 bar->start = 0;
4975 bar->end = 0;
4976 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4977 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
4979 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4980 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4981 bar->prev = Qnil;
4982 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
4983 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
4984 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4985 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4987 /* Map the window/widget. */
4988 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4990 #ifdef USE_GTK
4991 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4992 bar->x_window,
4993 top,
4994 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4995 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4996 max (height, 1));
4997 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4998 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4999 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5000 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5001 top,
5002 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5003 max (height, 1), 0);
5004 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5005 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5007 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5008 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5009 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5011 unblock_input ();
5012 return bar;
5016 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5018 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5020 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5021 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5022 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5023 events.)
5025 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5026 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5027 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5028 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5029 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5031 static void
5032 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5034 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5035 Window w = bar->x_window;
5036 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5037 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5039 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5040 if (! rebuild
5041 && start == bar->start
5042 && end == bar->end)
5043 return;
5045 block_input ();
5048 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5049 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5050 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5052 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5053 the distance between start and end. */
5055 int length = end - start;
5057 if (start < 0)
5058 start = 0;
5059 else if (start > top_range)
5060 start = top_range;
5061 end = start + length;
5063 if (end < start)
5064 end = start;
5065 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5066 end = top_range;
5069 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5070 bar->start = start;
5071 bar->end = end;
5073 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5074 if (end > top_range)
5075 end = top_range;
5077 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5078 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5079 that many pixels tall. */
5080 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5082 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5083 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5084 if (start > 0)
5085 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5086 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5087 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5088 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5089 inside_width, start,
5090 False);
5092 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5093 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5094 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5095 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5097 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5098 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5099 /* x, y, width, height */
5100 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5101 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5102 inside_width, end - start);
5104 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5105 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5106 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5107 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5109 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5110 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5111 if (end < inside_height)
5112 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5113 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5114 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5115 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5116 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5117 False);
5121 unblock_input ();
5124 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5126 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5127 nil. */
5129 static void
5130 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5132 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5133 block_input ();
5135 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5136 #ifdef USE_GTK
5137 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5138 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5139 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5140 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5141 #else
5142 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5143 #endif
5145 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5146 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5148 unblock_input ();
5152 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5153 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5154 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5155 create one. */
5157 static void
5158 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5160 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5161 Lisp_Object barobj;
5162 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5163 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5164 int window_y, window_height;
5165 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5166 int fringe_extended_p;
5167 #endif
5169 /* Get window dimensions. */
5170 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5171 top = window_y;
5172 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5173 height = window_height;
5175 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5176 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5178 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5179 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5180 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5181 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5182 else
5183 sb_width = width;
5185 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5186 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5187 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5188 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5189 else
5190 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5191 #else
5192 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5193 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5194 else
5195 sb_left = left;
5196 #endif
5198 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5199 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5200 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5201 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5202 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5203 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5204 else
5205 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5206 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5207 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5208 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5209 #endif
5211 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5212 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5214 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5216 block_input ();
5217 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5218 if (fringe_extended_p)
5219 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5220 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5221 else
5222 #endif
5223 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5224 left, top, width, height, False);
5225 unblock_input ();
5228 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5230 else
5232 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5233 unsigned int mask = 0;
5235 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5237 block_input ();
5239 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5240 mask |= CWX;
5241 if (top != bar->top)
5242 mask |= CWY;
5243 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5244 mask |= CWWidth;
5245 if (height != bar->height)
5246 mask |= CWHeight;
5248 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5250 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5251 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5253 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5254 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5255 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5257 if (fringe_extended_p)
5258 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5259 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5260 else
5261 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5262 left, top, width, height, False);
5264 #ifdef USE_GTK
5265 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5266 bar->x_window,
5267 top,
5268 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5269 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5270 max (height, 1));
5271 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5272 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5273 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5274 top,
5275 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5276 max (height, 1), 0);
5277 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5279 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5281 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5282 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5283 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5285 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5286 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5287 height, False);
5288 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5289 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5290 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5291 height, False);
5294 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5295 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5296 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5297 example. */
5299 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5300 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5301 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5303 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5304 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5305 left + area_width - rest, top,
5306 rest, height, False);
5307 else
5308 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5309 left, top, rest, height, False);
5313 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5314 if (mask)
5316 XWindowChanges wc;
5318 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5319 wc.y = top;
5320 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5321 wc.height = height;
5322 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5323 mask, &wc);
5326 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5328 /* Remember new settings. */
5329 bar->left = sb_left;
5330 bar->top = top;
5331 bar->width = sb_width;
5332 bar->height = height;
5334 unblock_input ();
5337 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5338 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5340 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5341 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5342 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5343 dragged. */
5344 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5346 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5348 if (whole == 0)
5349 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5350 else
5352 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5353 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5354 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5357 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5359 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5360 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5364 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5365 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5366 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5367 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5368 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5369 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5370 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5372 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5373 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5374 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5376 static void
5377 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5379 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5380 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5382 Lisp_Object bar;
5383 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5384 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5385 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5386 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5387 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5388 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5389 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5394 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5395 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5397 static void
5398 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5400 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5401 struct frame *f;
5402 Lisp_Object barobj;
5404 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5405 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5406 emacs_abort ();
5408 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5410 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5411 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5412 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5414 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5415 the lists. */
5416 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5417 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5418 return;
5419 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5420 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5421 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5422 else
5423 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5424 one or the other! */
5425 emacs_abort ();
5427 else
5428 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5430 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5431 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5433 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5434 bar->prev = Qnil;
5435 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5436 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5437 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5438 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5441 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5442 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5444 static void
5445 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5447 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5449 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5451 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5452 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5453 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5455 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5457 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5459 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5461 next = b->next;
5462 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5465 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5466 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5470 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5471 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5472 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5474 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5475 mark bits. */
5477 static void
5478 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5480 Window w = bar->x_window;
5481 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5482 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5483 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5485 block_input ();
5487 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5489 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5490 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5491 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5492 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5494 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5495 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5497 /* x, y, width, height */
5498 0, 0,
5499 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5500 bar->height - 1);
5502 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5503 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5504 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5505 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5507 unblock_input ();
5510 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5512 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5513 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5515 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5516 mark bits. */
5519 static void
5520 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5522 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5523 emacs_abort ();
5525 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5526 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5527 emacs_event->modifiers
5528 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5529 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5530 event->xbutton.state)
5531 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5532 ? up_modifier
5533 : down_modifier));
5534 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5535 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5536 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5538 int top_range
5539 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5540 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5542 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5543 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5545 if (y < bar->start)
5546 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5547 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5548 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5549 else
5550 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5552 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5553 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5554 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5555 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5557 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5558 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5560 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5561 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5563 #endif
5565 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5566 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5570 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5572 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5574 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5575 mark bits. */
5577 static void
5578 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5580 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5582 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5584 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5585 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5587 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5588 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5590 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5591 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5593 if (new_start != bar->start)
5595 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5597 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5602 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5604 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5605 on the scroll bar. */
5607 static void
5608 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5609 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5610 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5612 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5613 Window w = bar->x_window;
5614 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5615 int win_x, win_y;
5616 Window dummy_window;
5617 int dummy_coord;
5618 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5620 block_input ();
5622 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5623 report that. */
5624 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5626 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5627 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5628 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5630 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5631 &win_x, &win_y,
5633 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5634 &dummy_mask))
5636 else
5638 int top_range
5639 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5641 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5643 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5644 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5646 if (win_y < 0)
5647 win_y = 0;
5648 if (win_y > top_range)
5649 win_y = top_range;
5651 *fp = f;
5652 *bar_window = bar->window;
5654 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5655 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5656 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5657 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5658 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5659 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5660 else
5661 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5663 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5664 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5666 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5667 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5670 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5672 unblock_input ();
5676 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5677 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5678 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5679 redraw them. */
5681 static void
5682 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5684 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5685 Lisp_Object bar;
5687 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5688 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5689 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5690 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5691 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5692 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5693 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5694 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5695 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5696 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5700 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5702 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5703 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5704 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5705 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5707 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5708 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5710 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5712 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5713 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5715 static int temp_index;
5716 static short temp_buffer[100];
5718 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5719 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5720 temp_index = 0; \
5721 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5723 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5724 on a particular display. */
5726 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5728 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5729 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5730 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5731 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5733 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5735 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5736 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5737 do \
5739 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5740 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5741 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5742 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5743 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5744 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5746 while (0)
5747 #endif
5749 enum
5751 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5752 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5753 X_EVENT_DROP
5756 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5757 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5758 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5760 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5761 this event further.
5762 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5764 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5765 static int
5766 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5768 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5769 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5770 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5771 was created. */
5773 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5774 event->xclient.window);
5776 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5778 #endif
5780 #ifdef USE_GTK
5781 static int current_count;
5782 static int current_finish;
5783 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5785 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5786 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5787 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5788 static GdkFilterReturn
5789 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5791 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5793 block_input ();
5794 if (current_count >= 0)
5796 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5798 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5800 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5801 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5802 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5803 so we do it here. */
5804 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5805 && dpyinfo
5806 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5808 unblock_input ();
5809 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5811 #endif
5813 if (! dpyinfo)
5814 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5815 else
5816 current_count +=
5817 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5818 current_hold_quit);
5820 else
5821 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5823 unblock_input ();
5825 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5826 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5828 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5830 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5833 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5834 enum xembed_message,
5835 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5837 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5839 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5840 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5841 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5843 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5845 static int
5846 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5847 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5849 union {
5850 struct input_event ie;
5851 struct selection_input_event sie;
5852 } inev;
5853 int count = 0;
5854 int do_help = 0;
5855 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5856 struct frame *f = NULL;
5857 struct coding_system coding;
5858 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5859 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5860 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5862 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5864 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5865 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5866 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5868 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5869 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5871 switch (event.type)
5873 case ClientMessage:
5875 if (event.xclient.message_type
5876 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5877 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5879 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5880 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5882 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5883 could be the shell widget window
5884 if the frame has no title bar. */
5885 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5886 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5887 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5888 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5889 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5890 #endif
5891 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5892 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5893 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5894 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5895 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5896 needed.
5898 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5899 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5900 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5901 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5902 Emacs. */
5904 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5905 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5906 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5907 if (f)
5909 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5910 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5911 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5912 x_catch_errors (d);
5913 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5914 /* The ICCCM says this is
5915 the only valid choice. */
5916 RevertToParent,
5917 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5918 /* This is needed to detect the error
5919 if there is an error. */
5920 XSync (d, False);
5921 x_uncatch_errors ();
5923 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5924 #endif /* 0 */
5925 goto done;
5928 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5929 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5931 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5932 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5933 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5934 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5935 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5936 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5937 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5938 session manager and one for this. */
5939 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5940 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5941 #endif
5943 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5944 event.xclient.window);
5945 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5946 for a single Emacs process. */
5947 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5948 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5949 event.xclient.window,
5950 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5951 else if (f)
5952 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5953 event.xclient.window,
5954 0, 0);
5956 goto done;
5959 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5960 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5962 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5963 event.xclient.window);
5964 if (!f)
5965 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5967 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5968 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5969 goto done;
5972 goto done;
5975 if (event.xclient.message_type
5976 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5978 goto done;
5981 if (event.xclient.message_type
5982 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5984 int new_x, new_y;
5985 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5987 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5988 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5990 if (f)
5992 f->left_pos = new_x;
5993 f->top_pos = new_y;
5995 goto done;
5998 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5999 if (event.xclient.message_type
6000 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6002 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6003 if (f)
6004 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6005 &event, NULL);
6006 goto done;
6008 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6010 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6011 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6012 || (event.xclient.message_type
6013 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6015 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6016 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6017 currently never do because we are interested in
6018 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6019 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6020 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6021 if (!f)
6022 goto OTHER;
6023 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6024 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6025 goto done;
6028 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6029 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6030 we construct an input_event. */
6031 if (event.xclient.message_type
6032 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6034 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6035 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6036 goto done;
6038 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6040 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6041 if (event.xclient.message_type
6042 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6044 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6045 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6046 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6048 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6049 goto done;
6052 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6054 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6055 if (!f)
6056 goto OTHER;
6057 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6058 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6060 break;
6062 case SelectionNotify:
6063 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6064 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6065 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6066 goto OTHER;
6067 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6068 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6069 break;
6071 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6072 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6073 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6074 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6075 goto OTHER;
6076 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6078 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6080 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6081 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6082 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6083 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6085 break;
6087 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6088 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6089 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6090 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6091 goto OTHER;
6092 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6094 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6096 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6097 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6098 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6099 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6100 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6101 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6102 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6104 break;
6106 case PropertyNotify:
6107 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6108 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6109 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6110 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty)
6111 && FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
6112 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6114 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed.
6115 It hides the frame. So if our state says we aren't
6116 hidden anymore, treat it as deiconified. */
6117 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6118 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6119 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6120 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6121 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6122 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6125 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6126 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6127 goto OTHER;
6129 case ReparentNotify:
6130 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6131 if (f)
6133 int x, y;
6134 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6135 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6136 f->left_pos = x;
6137 f->top_pos = y;
6139 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6140 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6141 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6143 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6145 goto OTHER;
6147 case Expose:
6148 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6149 if (f)
6151 #ifdef USE_GTK
6152 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6153 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6154 event.xexpose.window,
6155 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6156 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6157 FALSE);
6158 #endif
6159 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
6161 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6162 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6163 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6164 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6166 else
6167 expose_frame (f,
6168 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6169 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6171 else
6173 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6174 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6175 #endif
6176 #if defined USE_LUCID
6177 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6178 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6179 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6181 Widget widget
6182 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6183 if (widget)
6184 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6186 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6188 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6189 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6190 goto OTHER;
6191 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6192 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6193 event.xexpose.window);
6195 if (bar)
6196 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6197 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6198 else
6199 goto OTHER;
6200 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6201 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6203 break;
6205 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6206 source area was obscured or not
6207 available. */
6208 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6209 if (f)
6211 expose_frame (f,
6212 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6213 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6214 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6216 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6217 else
6218 goto OTHER;
6219 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6220 break;
6222 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6223 source area was completely
6224 available. */
6225 break;
6227 case UnmapNotify:
6228 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6229 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6231 tip_window = 0;
6232 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6235 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6236 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6237 the frame was deleted. */
6239 bool visible = FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);
6240 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6241 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6242 display that won't ever be seen. */
6243 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
6244 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6245 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6246 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6247 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6248 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6249 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6250 if (visible || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6252 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
6253 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6254 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6257 goto OTHER;
6259 case MapNotify:
6260 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6261 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6262 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6263 goto OTHER;
6265 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6266 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6267 frame is visible. */
6268 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6269 if (f)
6271 bool iconified = FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
6272 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6273 the frame's display structures.
6274 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6275 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6276 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6277 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6278 if (!iconified)
6279 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6281 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6282 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6283 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6284 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6286 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 1);
6287 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
6288 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6290 if (iconified)
6292 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6293 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6295 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list) && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6296 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later to update the
6297 frame titles in case this is the second frame. */
6298 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6300 #ifdef USE_GTK
6301 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6302 #endif
6304 goto OTHER;
6306 case KeyPress:
6308 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6309 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6311 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6312 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6313 if (popup_activated ())
6314 goto OTHER;
6315 #endif
6317 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6319 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6320 mouse highlighting. */
6321 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6322 && (f == 0
6323 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6325 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6326 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6329 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6330 if (f == 0)
6332 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6333 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6334 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6335 event.xkey.window);
6336 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6338 widget = XtParent (widget);
6339 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6342 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6344 if (f != 0)
6346 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6347 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6348 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6349 his Emacs hang.
6351 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6352 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6353 status_return even if the input is too long to
6354 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6355 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6356 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6357 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6358 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6359 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6360 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6361 int modifiers;
6362 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6363 Lisp_Object c;
6365 #ifdef USE_GTK
6366 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6367 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6368 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6369 (see above). */
6370 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6371 #endif
6373 event.xkey.state
6374 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6375 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6376 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6378 /* This will have to go some day... */
6380 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6381 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6382 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6383 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6384 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6385 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6386 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6388 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6389 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6390 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6391 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6392 not it is combined with Meta. */
6393 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6394 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6396 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6397 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6399 Status status_return;
6401 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6402 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6403 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6404 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6405 &status_return);
6406 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6408 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6409 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6410 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6411 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6412 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6413 &status_return);
6415 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6416 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6417 break;
6418 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6420 keysym = NoSymbol;
6421 modifiers = 0;
6423 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6424 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6425 emacs_abort ();
6427 else
6428 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6429 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6430 &compose_status);
6431 #else
6432 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6433 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6434 &compose_status);
6435 #endif
6437 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6438 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6439 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6440 break;
6442 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6443 orig_keysym = keysym;
6445 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6446 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6447 inev.ie.modifiers
6448 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6449 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6451 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6452 translations to characters. */
6453 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6454 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6456 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6457 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6458 goto done_keysym;
6461 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6462 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6464 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6465 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6466 else
6467 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6468 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6469 goto done_keysym;
6472 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6473 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6474 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6475 Vx_keysym_table,
6476 Qnil),
6477 NATNUMP (c)))
6479 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6480 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6481 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6482 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6483 goto done_keysym;
6486 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6487 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6488 || keysym == XK_Delete
6489 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6490 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6491 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6492 #endif
6493 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6494 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6495 #ifdef HPUX
6496 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6497 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6498 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6499 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6500 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6501 #endif
6502 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6503 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6504 #endif
6505 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6506 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6507 #endif
6508 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6509 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6510 #endif
6511 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6512 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6513 #endif
6514 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6515 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6516 #endif
6517 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6518 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6519 #endif
6520 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6521 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6522 #endif
6523 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6524 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6525 #endif
6526 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6527 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6528 #endif
6529 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6530 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6531 #endif
6532 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6533 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6534 #endif
6535 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6536 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6537 #endif
6538 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6539 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6540 #endif
6541 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6542 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6543 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6544 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6545 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6546 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6547 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6548 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6549 don't have real modifiers but
6550 should be treated similarly to
6551 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6552 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6553 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6554 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6555 #endif
6558 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6559 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6560 key. */
6561 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6562 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6563 goto done_keysym;
6566 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6567 ptrdiff_t i;
6568 int nchars, len;
6570 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6572 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6573 nchars++;
6574 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6577 if (nchars < nbytes)
6579 /* Decode the input data. */
6581 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6582 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6583 we used just above and the locale. */
6584 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6585 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6586 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6587 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6588 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6589 gives us composition information. */
6590 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6592 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6593 nbytes);
6594 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6595 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6596 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6597 nbytes = coding.produced;
6598 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6599 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6602 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6603 character events. */
6604 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6606 int ch;
6607 if (nchars == nbytes)
6608 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6609 else
6610 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6611 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6612 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6613 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6614 inev.ie.code = ch;
6615 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6618 count += nchars;
6620 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6622 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6623 break;
6626 done_keysym:
6627 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6628 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6629 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6630 client. */
6631 break;
6632 #else
6633 goto OTHER;
6634 #endif
6636 case KeyRelease:
6637 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6638 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6639 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6640 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6641 client. */
6642 break;
6643 #else
6644 goto OTHER;
6645 #endif
6647 case EnterNotify:
6648 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6649 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6651 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6653 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6654 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6656 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6657 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6658 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6659 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6660 #ifdef USE_GTK
6661 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6662 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6663 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6664 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6665 #endif
6666 goto OTHER;
6668 case FocusIn:
6669 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6670 goto OTHER;
6672 case LeaveNotify:
6673 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6674 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6676 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6677 if (f)
6679 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6681 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6682 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6683 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6684 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6687 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6688 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6689 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6690 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6691 if (any_help_event_p)
6692 do_help = -1;
6694 #ifdef USE_GTK
6695 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6696 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6697 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6698 #endif
6699 goto OTHER;
6701 case FocusOut:
6702 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6703 goto OTHER;
6705 case MotionNotify:
6707 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6708 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6709 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6711 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6712 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6713 f = last_mouse_frame;
6714 else
6715 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6717 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6719 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6720 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6723 #ifdef USE_GTK
6724 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6725 f = 0;
6726 #endif
6727 if (f)
6730 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6731 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6732 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6734 Lisp_Object window;
6736 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6737 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6738 0, 0);
6740 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6741 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6742 will be selected only when it is active. */
6743 if (WINDOWP (window)
6744 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6745 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6746 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6747 create event iff we don't leave the
6748 selected frame. */
6749 && (focus_follows_mouse
6750 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6751 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6753 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6754 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6757 last_window=window;
6759 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6760 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6762 else
6764 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6765 struct scroll_bar *bar
6766 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6767 event.xmotion.window);
6769 if (bar)
6770 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6771 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6773 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6774 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6775 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6778 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6779 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6780 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6781 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6782 do_help = 1;
6783 goto OTHER;
6786 case ConfigureNotify:
6787 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6788 #ifdef USE_GTK
6789 if (!f
6790 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6791 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6793 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6794 event.xconfigure.height);
6795 f = 0;
6797 #endif
6798 if (f)
6800 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6801 #ifndef USE_GTK
6802 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6803 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6805 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6806 is called by the code that handles resizing
6807 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6809 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6810 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6811 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6812 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6813 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6814 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6815 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6817 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6818 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6819 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6822 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6823 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6824 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6825 #endif
6827 #ifdef USE_GTK
6828 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6829 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6830 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6831 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6832 #endif
6834 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6837 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6838 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6839 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6840 #endif
6843 goto OTHER;
6845 case ButtonRelease:
6846 case ButtonPress:
6848 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6849 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6850 bool tool_bar_p = 0;
6852 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6853 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6854 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6856 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6857 && last_mouse_frame
6858 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6859 f = last_mouse_frame;
6860 else
6861 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6863 #ifdef USE_GTK
6864 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6865 f = 0;
6866 #endif
6867 if (f)
6869 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6870 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6871 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6873 Lisp_Object window;
6874 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6875 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6877 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6878 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6880 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6882 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6883 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6884 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6885 event.xbutton.state));
6889 if (!tool_bar_p)
6890 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6891 if (! popup_activated ())
6892 #endif
6894 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6896 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6897 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6899 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6900 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6902 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6903 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6905 else
6906 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6908 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6909 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6910 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6912 else
6914 struct scroll_bar *bar
6915 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6916 event.xbutton.window);
6918 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6919 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6920 scroll bars. */
6921 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6923 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6924 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6926 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6927 if (bar)
6928 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6929 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6932 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6934 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6935 last_mouse_frame = f;
6937 if (!tool_bar_p)
6938 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6940 else
6941 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6943 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6944 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6945 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6946 if (f != 0)
6947 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6949 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6950 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6951 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6952 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6953 Instead, save it away
6954 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6955 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6956 if (! popup_activated ()
6957 #ifdef USE_GTK
6958 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6959 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6960 #endif
6961 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6962 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6963 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6964 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6965 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6966 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6967 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6968 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6970 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6971 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6973 else
6974 goto OTHER;
6975 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6977 break;
6979 case CirculateNotify:
6980 goto OTHER;
6982 case CirculateRequest:
6983 goto OTHER;
6985 case VisibilityNotify:
6986 goto OTHER;
6988 case MappingNotify:
6989 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6990 local cache. */
6991 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6993 case MappingModifier:
6994 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6995 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6996 case MappingKeyboard:
6997 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6999 goto OTHER;
7001 case DestroyNotify:
7002 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7003 break;
7005 default:
7006 OTHER:
7007 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7008 block_input ();
7009 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7010 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7011 unblock_input ();
7012 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7013 break;
7016 done:
7017 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7019 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7020 count++;
7023 if (do_help
7024 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7026 Lisp_Object frame;
7028 if (f)
7029 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7030 else
7031 frame = Qnil;
7033 if (do_help > 0)
7035 any_help_event_p = 1;
7036 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7037 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7039 else
7041 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7042 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7044 count++;
7047 SAFE_FREE ();
7048 *eventptr = event;
7049 return count;
7052 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7054 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7055 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7056 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7058 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7060 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7062 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7063 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7065 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7067 if (dpyinfo)
7068 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7070 return finish;
7072 #endif
7075 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7076 Return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7078 Return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7079 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7080 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7081 C chars). */
7083 static int
7084 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7086 int count = 0;
7087 int event_found = 0;
7089 block_input ();
7091 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7092 input_signal_count++;
7094 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7095 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7097 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7098 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7101 #ifndef USE_GTK
7102 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7104 int finish;
7105 XEvent event;
7107 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7109 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7110 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7111 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7112 continue;
7113 #endif
7114 event_found = 1;
7116 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7117 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7119 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7120 goto out;
7123 out:;
7125 #else /* USE_GTK */
7127 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7128 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7129 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7130 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7132 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7133 from all displays. */
7135 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7137 current_count = count;
7138 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7140 gtk_main_iteration ();
7142 count = current_count;
7143 current_count = -1;
7144 current_hold_quit = 0;
7146 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7147 break;
7149 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7151 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7152 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7153 if (! event_found)
7155 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7156 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7157 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7158 x_noop_count++;
7159 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7161 x_noop_count=0;
7163 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7164 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7166 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7168 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7169 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7173 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7174 raise it now. */
7175 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7176 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7178 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7179 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7182 unblock_input ();
7184 return count;
7190 /***********************************************************************
7191 Text Cursor
7192 ***********************************************************************/
7194 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7195 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7197 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7198 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7199 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7201 static void
7202 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7204 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7205 XRectangle clip_rect;
7206 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7208 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7210 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7211 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7212 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7213 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7214 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7216 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7220 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7222 static void
7223 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7225 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7226 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7227 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7228 int x, y, wd, h;
7229 XGCValues xgcv;
7230 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7231 GC gc;
7233 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7234 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7235 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7236 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7237 return;
7239 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7240 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7241 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7243 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7244 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7245 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7246 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7247 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7248 else
7249 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7250 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7251 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7253 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7254 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7255 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7256 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7260 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7262 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7263 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7264 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7265 --gerd. */
7267 static void
7268 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7270 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7271 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7273 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7274 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7275 and mini-buffer. */
7276 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7277 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7278 return;
7280 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7281 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7282 the bar might not be in the window. */
7283 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7285 struct glyph_row *r;
7286 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7287 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7289 else
7291 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7292 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7293 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7294 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7295 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7296 XGCValues xgcv;
7298 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7299 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7300 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7301 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7302 that the glyph is legible. */
7303 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7304 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7305 else
7306 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7307 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7309 if (gc)
7310 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7311 else
7313 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7314 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7317 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7319 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7321 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7323 if (width < 0)
7324 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7325 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7327 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7329 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7330 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7331 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7332 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7334 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7335 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7336 width, row->height);
7338 else
7340 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7342 if (width < 0)
7343 width = row->height;
7345 width = min (row->height, width);
7347 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7348 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7350 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7351 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7352 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7353 row->height - width),
7354 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7357 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7362 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7364 static void
7365 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7367 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7368 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7369 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7370 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7374 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7376 static void
7377 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7379 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7380 x, y, width, height, False);
7381 #ifdef USE_GTK
7382 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7383 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7384 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7385 #endif
7389 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7391 static void
7392 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7394 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7396 if (on_p)
7398 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7399 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7401 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7402 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7403 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7404 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7406 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7407 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7409 else
7411 switch (cursor_type)
7413 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7414 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7415 break;
7417 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7418 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7419 break;
7421 case BAR_CURSOR:
7422 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7423 break;
7425 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7426 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7427 break;
7429 case NO_CURSOR:
7430 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7431 break;
7433 default:
7434 emacs_abort ();
7438 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7439 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7440 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7441 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7442 #endif
7445 #ifndef XFlush
7446 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7447 #endif
7451 /* Icons. */
7453 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7456 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7458 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7460 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7461 return 1;
7463 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7464 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7465 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7466 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7468 if (STRINGP (file))
7470 #ifdef USE_GTK
7471 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7472 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7473 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7474 return 0;
7475 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7476 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7477 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7479 else
7481 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7482 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7484 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7486 #ifdef USE_GTK
7488 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7489 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7490 return 0;
7492 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7494 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7495 if (rc != -1)
7496 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7498 #endif
7500 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7501 if (rc == -1)
7503 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7504 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7505 if (rc == -1)
7506 return 1;
7508 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7509 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7513 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7514 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7515 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7516 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7517 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7519 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7522 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7523 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7525 return 0;
7529 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7530 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7533 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7535 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7536 return 1;
7539 XTextProperty text;
7540 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7541 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7542 text.format = 8;
7543 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7544 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7547 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7548 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7549 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7550 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7552 return 0;
7555 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7557 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7558 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7560 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7561 be called from a signal handler.
7564 struct x_error_message_stack {
7565 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7566 Display *dpy;
7567 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7569 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7571 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7572 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7573 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7575 static void
7576 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7578 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7579 x_error_message->string,
7580 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7583 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7584 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7585 operating on.
7587 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7588 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7589 stored in *x_error_message.
7591 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7592 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7594 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7596 void
7597 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7599 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7601 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7602 XSync (dpy, False);
7604 data->dpy = dpy;
7605 data->string[0] = 0;
7606 data->prev = x_error_message;
7607 x_error_message = data;
7610 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7611 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7613 void
7614 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7616 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7618 block_input ();
7620 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7621 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7622 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7623 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7625 tmp = x_error_message;
7626 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7627 xfree (tmp);
7628 unblock_input ();
7631 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7632 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7633 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7635 void
7636 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7638 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7639 XSync (dpy, False);
7641 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7643 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7644 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7645 x_uncatch_errors ();
7646 error (format, string);
7650 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7651 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7653 bool
7654 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7656 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7657 XSync (dpy, False);
7659 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7662 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7664 void
7665 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7667 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7670 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7671 * idea. --lorentey */
7672 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7674 void
7675 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7677 while (x_error_message)
7678 x_uncatch_errors ();
7680 #endif
7682 #if 0
7683 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7684 x_trace_wire (void)
7686 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7688 #endif /* ! 0 */
7691 /************************************************************************
7692 Handling X errors
7693 ************************************************************************/
7695 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7697 static char *error_msg;
7699 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7700 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7702 static void
7703 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7705 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7706 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7707 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7709 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7710 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7712 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7713 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7715 if (dpyinfo)
7717 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7718 frame on it. */
7719 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7720 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7723 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7724 that are on the dead display. */
7725 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7727 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7728 minibuf_frame
7729 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7730 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7731 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7732 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7733 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7734 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7737 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7738 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7739 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7740 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7741 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7742 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7744 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7745 trying to find a replacement. */
7746 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7747 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7750 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7751 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7752 if (dpyinfo)
7754 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7755 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7756 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7757 #ifdef USE_GTK
7758 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7759 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7760 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7761 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7762 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7763 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7764 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7765 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7766 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7767 error_msg);
7768 emacs_abort ();
7769 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7771 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7772 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7774 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7775 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7776 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7777 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7778 emacs_abort ();
7781 Lisp_Object tmp;
7782 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7783 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7787 if (terminal_list == 0)
7789 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7790 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7791 /* NOTREACHED */
7794 totally_unblock_input ();
7796 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7797 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7799 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7800 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7802 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7803 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7804 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7805 error ("%s", error_msg);
7808 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7809 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7810 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7812 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7813 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7815 static int
7816 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7818 #if defined USE_GTK && defined HAVE_GTK3
7819 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7820 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7821 && event->minor_code == 0)
7823 return 0;
7825 #endif
7827 if (x_error_message)
7828 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7829 else
7830 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7831 return 0;
7834 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7835 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7836 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7838 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7840 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7841 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7843 static void NO_INLINE
7844 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7846 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7848 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7849 or colors that are not defined. */
7851 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7852 return;
7854 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7855 original error handler. */
7857 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7858 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7859 buf, event->request_code);
7860 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7864 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7865 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7866 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7868 static int
7869 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7871 char buf[256];
7873 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7874 DisplayString (display));
7875 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7876 return 0;
7879 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7881 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7882 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7883 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7884 FONT-OBJECT. */
7886 Lisp_Object
7887 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7889 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7891 if (fontset < 0)
7892 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7893 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7894 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7895 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7896 do. */
7897 return font_object;
7899 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7900 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7901 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7902 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7904 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7906 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7907 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7909 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7910 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7911 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7913 else
7915 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7916 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7919 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7921 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7922 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7923 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7924 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7925 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7928 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7929 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7930 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7932 block_input ();
7933 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7934 unblock_input ();
7936 #endif
7938 return font_object;
7942 /***********************************************************************
7943 X Input Methods
7944 ***********************************************************************/
7946 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7948 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7950 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7951 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7952 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7954 static void
7955 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
7957 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7958 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7960 block_input ();
7962 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7963 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7965 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7966 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7968 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7969 xic_free_xfontset (f);
7973 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7974 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7975 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7976 unblock_input ();
7979 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7981 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7982 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7983 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
7984 #endif
7986 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7987 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7989 static void
7990 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
7992 XIM xim;
7994 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7995 if (use_xim)
7997 if (dpyinfo->xim)
7998 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
7999 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8000 emacs_class);
8001 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8003 if (xim)
8005 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8006 XIMCallback destroy;
8007 #endif
8009 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8010 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8012 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8013 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8014 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8015 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8016 #endif
8020 else
8021 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8022 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8026 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8028 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8029 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8030 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8031 when the callback was registered. */
8033 static void
8034 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8036 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8037 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8039 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8040 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8041 return;
8043 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8045 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8046 as they have no XIC. */
8047 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8049 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8051 block_input ();
8052 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8054 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8056 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8057 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8058 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8060 create_frame_xic (f);
8061 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8062 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8063 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8065 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8066 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8071 unblock_input ();
8075 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8078 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8079 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8080 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8081 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8083 static void
8084 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8086 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8087 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8088 if (use_xim)
8090 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8091 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8092 ptrdiff_t len;
8094 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8095 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8096 len = strlen (resource_name);
8097 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8098 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8099 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8100 resource_name, emacs_class,
8101 xim_instantiate_callback,
8102 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8103 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8104 least, hence the configure test. */
8105 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8106 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8107 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8108 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8110 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8114 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8116 static void
8117 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8119 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8120 if (use_xim)
8122 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8123 if (dpyinfo->display)
8124 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8125 NULL, emacs_class,
8126 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8127 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8128 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8129 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8130 if (dpyinfo->display)
8131 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8132 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8133 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8135 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8138 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8142 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8143 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8145 static void
8146 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8148 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8150 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8151 is already for the top-left corner. */
8152 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8153 return;
8155 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8156 position that fits on the screen. */
8157 if (flags & XNegative)
8158 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8159 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8162 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8164 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8165 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8166 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8168 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8169 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8170 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8171 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8172 is right, though.
8174 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8175 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8177 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8178 #endif
8180 if (flags & YNegative)
8181 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8182 - height + f->top_pos;
8185 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8186 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8187 so the flags should correspond. */
8188 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8191 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8192 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8193 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8194 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8195 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8197 void
8198 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8200 int modified_top, modified_left;
8202 if (change_gravity > 0)
8204 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8205 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8207 f->top_pos = yoff;
8208 f->left_pos = xoff;
8209 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8210 if (xoff < 0)
8211 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8212 if (yoff < 0)
8213 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8214 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8216 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8218 block_input ();
8219 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8221 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8222 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8224 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8226 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8227 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8228 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8229 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8230 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8233 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8234 modified_left, modified_top);
8236 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8237 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8238 ? 1 : 0);
8240 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8241 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8242 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8243 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8244 of the frame.
8246 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8247 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8248 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8250 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8251 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8252 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8253 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8254 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8255 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8257 unblock_input ();
8260 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8261 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8262 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8263 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8264 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8266 static int
8267 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8269 Atom actual_type;
8270 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8271 int i, rc, actual_format;
8272 Window wmcheck_window;
8273 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8274 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8275 long max_len = 65536;
8276 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8277 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8278 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8280 block_input ();
8282 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8283 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8284 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8285 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8286 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8287 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8289 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8291 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8292 x_uncatch_errors ();
8293 unblock_input ();
8294 return 0;
8297 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8298 XFree (tmp_data);
8300 /* Check if window exists. */
8301 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8302 x_sync (f);
8303 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8305 x_uncatch_errors ();
8306 unblock_input ();
8307 return 0;
8310 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8312 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8313 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8314 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8315 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8316 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8317 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8319 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8320 tmp_data = NULL;
8321 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8322 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8323 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8324 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8325 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8327 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8329 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8330 x_uncatch_errors ();
8331 unblock_input ();
8332 return 0;
8335 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8336 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8337 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8340 rc = 0;
8342 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8343 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8345 x_uncatch_errors ();
8346 unblock_input ();
8348 return rc;
8351 static void
8352 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8354 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8356 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8357 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8358 make_number (32),
8359 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8360 Fcons
8361 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8362 Fcons
8363 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8364 (value != 0
8365 ? list1 (make_fixnum_or_float (value))
8366 : Qnil))));
8369 void
8370 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8372 Lisp_Object frame;
8373 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8375 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8377 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8378 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8381 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8382 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8383 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8385 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8387 static int
8388 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8389 Window window,
8390 int *size_state,
8391 int *sticky)
8393 Atom actual_type;
8394 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8395 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8396 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8397 long max_len = 65536;
8398 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8399 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8400 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8402 *sticky = 0;
8403 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8405 block_input ();
8406 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8407 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8408 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8409 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8410 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8412 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8414 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8415 x_uncatch_errors ();
8416 unblock_input ();
8417 return !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f);
8420 x_uncatch_errors ();
8422 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8424 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8425 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8427 is_hidden = 1;
8428 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8430 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8432 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8433 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8434 else
8435 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8437 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8439 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8440 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8441 else
8442 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8444 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8445 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8446 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8447 *sticky = 1;
8450 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8451 unblock_input ();
8452 return ! is_hidden;
8455 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8457 static int
8458 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8460 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8461 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8462 int cur, dummy;
8464 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8466 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8467 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8468 if (!have_net_atom)
8469 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8471 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8473 Lisp_Object frame;
8475 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8477 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8478 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8479 are sent at once. */
8480 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8482 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8483 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8484 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8485 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8486 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8487 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8488 break;
8489 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8490 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8491 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8492 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8493 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8494 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8495 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8496 break;
8497 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8498 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8499 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8500 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8501 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8502 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8503 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8504 break;
8505 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8506 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8507 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8508 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8509 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8510 break;
8511 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8512 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8513 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8514 else
8515 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8516 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8519 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8523 return have_net_atom;
8526 static void
8527 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8529 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8531 block_input ();
8532 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8533 x_sync (f);
8534 unblock_input ();
8539 static int
8540 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8542 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8543 Lisp_Object lval;
8544 int sticky = 0;
8545 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8547 lval = Qnil;
8548 switch (value)
8550 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8551 lval = Qfullwidth;
8552 break;
8553 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8554 lval = Qfullheight;
8555 break;
8556 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8557 lval = Qfullboth;
8558 break;
8559 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8560 lval = Qmaximized;
8561 break;
8564 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8565 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8567 return not_hidden;
8570 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8571 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8572 static void
8573 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8575 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8576 return;
8578 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8579 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8581 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8582 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8583 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8585 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8587 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8588 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8590 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8592 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8593 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8594 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8595 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8596 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8597 break;
8598 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8599 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8600 break;
8601 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8602 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8605 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8606 width, height);
8610 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8611 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8612 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8613 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8614 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8615 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8616 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8618 static void
8619 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8621 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8623 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8624 window manager window around the frame. */
8626 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8628 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8630 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8632 int adjusted_left;
8633 int adjusted_top;
8635 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8636 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8637 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8639 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8641 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8642 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8644 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8645 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8647 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8649 else
8650 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8651 frame's position. */
8653 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8657 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8658 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8659 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8660 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8661 of an exact comparison. */
8663 static void
8664 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8666 int count = 0;
8668 while (count++ < 50)
8670 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8672 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8673 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8674 loop. */
8676 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8677 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8679 if (fuzzy)
8681 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8682 pixels. */
8684 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8685 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8686 return;
8688 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8689 return;
8692 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8693 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8695 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8699 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8700 void
8701 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8703 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8705 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8706 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8707 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8709 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8710 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8712 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8713 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8714 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8715 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8717 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8719 pending_signals = 1;
8720 totally_unblock_input ();
8721 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8722 block_input ();
8723 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8725 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8726 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8728 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8729 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8730 break;
8732 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8733 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8734 break; /* Timeout */
8736 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8737 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8741 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8742 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8743 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8744 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8746 static void
8747 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8749 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8751 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8752 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8753 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8755 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8757 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8759 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8760 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8761 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8762 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8764 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8765 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8766 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8767 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8770 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8771 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8772 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8773 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8774 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8776 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8777 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8778 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8779 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8781 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8782 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8783 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8784 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8785 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8787 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8788 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8790 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8791 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8792 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8793 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8794 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8795 else
8797 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8798 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8799 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8800 x_sync (f);
8805 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8806 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8807 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8808 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8810 void
8811 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8813 block_input ();
8815 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8817 int r, c;
8819 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8820 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8821 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8822 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8823 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8824 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8825 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8826 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8827 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8828 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8829 is however. */
8830 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8831 #endif
8832 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8833 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8834 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8835 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8836 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8837 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8838 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8841 #ifdef USE_GTK
8842 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8843 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8844 else
8845 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8846 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8848 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8850 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8852 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8853 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8855 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8856 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8857 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8858 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8859 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8861 unblock_input ();
8864 /* Mouse warping. */
8866 void
8867 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8869 int pix_x, pix_y;
8871 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8872 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8874 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8875 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8877 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8878 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8880 block_input ();
8882 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8883 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8884 unblock_input ();
8887 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8889 void
8890 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8892 block_input ();
8894 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8895 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8896 unblock_input ();
8899 /* Raise frame F. */
8901 void
8902 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8904 block_input ();
8905 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8906 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8907 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8908 unblock_input ();
8911 /* Lower frame F. */
8913 static void
8914 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
8916 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8918 block_input ();
8919 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8920 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8921 unblock_input ();
8925 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
8927 void
8928 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
8930 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
8931 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
8932 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8933 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
8934 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
8937 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
8939 void
8940 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
8942 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8943 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
8945 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8947 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
8949 Lisp_Object frame;
8950 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8951 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8952 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
8953 make_number (32), list2i (1, last_user_time));
8957 static void
8958 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
8960 if (raise_flag)
8961 x_raise_frame (f);
8962 else
8963 x_lower_frame (f);
8966 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8968 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
8970 /* XEmbed implementation. */
8972 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
8974 static void
8975 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
8977 unsigned long data[2];
8978 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8980 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
8981 data[1] = flags;
8983 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8984 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
8985 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
8987 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
8989 static void
8990 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
8991 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
8993 XEvent event;
8995 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8996 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
8997 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
8998 event.xclient.format = 32;
8999 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9000 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9001 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9002 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9003 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9005 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9006 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9007 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9010 /* Change of visibility. */
9012 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9013 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9014 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9015 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9016 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9017 finishes with it. */
9019 void
9020 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9022 Lisp_Object type;
9023 int original_top, original_left;
9024 int retry_count = 2;
9026 retry:
9028 block_input ();
9030 type = x_icon_type (f);
9031 if (!NILP (type))
9032 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9034 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9036 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9037 call x_set_offset a second time
9038 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9039 before the window gets really visible. */
9040 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9041 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9042 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9043 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9045 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9047 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9048 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9049 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9050 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9051 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9052 else
9054 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9055 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9057 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9058 #ifdef USE_GTK
9059 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9060 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9061 #else
9062 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9063 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9064 else
9065 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9066 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9067 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9070 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9072 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9073 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9074 so that incoming events are handled. */
9076 Lisp_Object frame;
9077 int count;
9078 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9079 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9080 will set it when they are handled. */
9081 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9083 original_left = f->left_pos;
9084 original_top = f->top_pos;
9086 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9087 unblock_input ();
9089 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9091 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9092 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9093 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9094 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9096 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9097 because the window manager may choose the position
9098 and we don't want to override it. */
9100 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9101 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9102 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9103 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9104 && previously_visible)
9106 Drawable rootw;
9107 int x, y;
9108 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9110 block_input ();
9112 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9113 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9114 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9115 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9116 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9117 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9118 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9119 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9120 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9122 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9123 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9124 original_left, original_top);
9126 unblock_input ();
9129 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9131 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9132 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9133 MapNotify at all.. */
9134 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9135 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9137 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9138 x_sync (f);
9140 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9141 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9142 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9143 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9144 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9145 probably a bug. */
9146 if (input_polling_used ())
9148 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9149 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9150 handler reset it. */
9151 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9152 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9153 poll_for_input_1 ();
9154 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9158 /* 2000-09-28: In
9160 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9161 (iconify-frame f)
9162 (raise-frame f))
9164 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9165 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9166 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9167 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9169 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9170 goto retry;
9174 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9176 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9178 void
9179 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9181 Window window;
9183 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9184 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9186 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9187 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9188 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9190 block_input ();
9192 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9193 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9194 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9195 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9196 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9197 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9199 #ifdef USE_GTK
9200 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9201 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9202 else
9203 #else
9204 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9205 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9206 else
9207 #endif
9210 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9211 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9213 unblock_input ();
9214 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9218 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9219 just by the event that we get from the server.
9220 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9221 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9222 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9223 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9224 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 0);
9226 x_sync (f);
9228 unblock_input ();
9231 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9233 void
9234 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9236 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9237 int result;
9238 #endif
9239 Lisp_Object type;
9241 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9242 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9243 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9245 if (FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
9246 return;
9248 block_input ();
9250 type = x_icon_type (f);
9251 if (!NILP (type))
9252 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9254 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9255 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9257 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9258 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9260 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9261 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9262 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9263 unblock_input ();
9264 return;
9266 #endif
9268 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9270 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9272 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9273 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9274 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9275 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9276 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9277 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9278 so we have to record it here. */
9279 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9280 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9281 unblock_input ();
9282 return;
9285 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9286 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9287 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9288 unblock_input ();
9290 if (!result)
9291 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9293 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9294 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9296 block_input ();
9297 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9298 unblock_input ();
9299 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9301 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9302 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9303 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9304 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9305 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9306 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9308 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9309 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9311 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9312 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9314 XEvent msg;
9316 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9317 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9318 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9319 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9320 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9322 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9323 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9324 False,
9325 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9326 &msg))
9328 unblock_input ();
9329 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9333 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9334 IconicState. */
9335 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9337 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9339 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9340 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9343 SET_FRAME_ICONIFIED (f, 1);
9344 SET_FRAME_VISIBLE (f, 0);
9346 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9347 unblock_input ();
9348 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9352 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9354 void
9355 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9357 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9358 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9359 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9360 Lisp_Object bar;
9361 struct scroll_bar *b;
9362 #endif
9364 block_input ();
9366 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9367 commands to the X server. */
9368 if (dpyinfo->display)
9370 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9371 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9372 face. */
9373 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9374 free_frame_faces (f);
9376 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9377 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9379 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9380 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9381 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9382 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9383 toolkit scroll bars. */
9384 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9386 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9387 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9389 #endif
9391 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9392 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9393 free_frame_xic (f);
9394 #endif
9396 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9397 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9399 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9400 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9402 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9403 we are using a toolkit. */
9404 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9405 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9407 free_frame_menubar (f);
9408 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9410 #ifdef USE_GTK
9411 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9412 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9414 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9415 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9416 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9418 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9419 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9420 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9421 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9422 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9423 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9425 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9426 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9427 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9428 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9429 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9430 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9431 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9432 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9433 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9434 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9435 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9436 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9437 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9438 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9439 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9441 x_free_gcs (f);
9443 /* Free extra GCs allocated by x_setup_relief_colors. */
9444 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc)
9446 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc);
9447 f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc = 0;
9449 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc)
9451 XFreeGC (dpyinfo->display, f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc);
9452 f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc = 0;
9455 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9458 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9459 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9460 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9462 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9463 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9464 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9465 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9466 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9467 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9469 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9471 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9472 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9473 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9474 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9475 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9476 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9479 unblock_input ();
9483 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9485 static void
9486 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9488 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9490 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9491 commands to the X server. */
9492 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9493 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9495 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9499 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9501 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9502 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9503 that the window now has.
9504 If USER_POSITION, set the USPosition
9505 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9506 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c. */
9508 #ifndef USE_GTK
9509 void
9510 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, bool user_position)
9512 XSizeHints size_hints;
9513 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9515 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9516 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9518 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9519 return;
9521 #endif
9523 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9524 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9526 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9527 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9529 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9530 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9532 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9533 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9534 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9535 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9536 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9537 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9539 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9541 int base_width, base_height;
9542 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9544 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9545 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9547 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9549 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9550 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9551 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9552 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9553 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9555 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9556 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9557 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9559 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9560 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9561 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9562 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9563 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9566 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9567 if (flags)
9569 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9570 goto no_read;
9574 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9575 long supplied_return;
9576 int value;
9578 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9579 &supplied_return);
9581 if (flags)
9582 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9583 else
9585 if (value == 0)
9586 hints.flags = 0;
9587 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9588 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9589 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9590 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9591 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9592 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9593 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9594 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9598 no_read:
9600 #ifdef PWinGravity
9601 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9602 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9604 if (user_position)
9606 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9607 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9609 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9611 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9613 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9615 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9617 static void
9618 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9620 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9621 Arg al[1];
9623 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9624 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9625 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9626 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9628 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9629 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9631 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9632 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9635 static void
9636 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9638 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9640 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9641 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9642 #endif
9644 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9646 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9647 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9648 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9649 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9651 else
9653 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9654 pixmap. */
9655 return;
9659 #ifdef USE_GTK
9661 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9662 return;
9665 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9668 Arg al[1];
9669 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9670 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9671 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9672 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9675 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9677 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9678 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9680 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9683 void
9684 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9686 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9688 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9689 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9690 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9692 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9696 /***********************************************************************
9697 Fonts
9698 ***********************************************************************/
9700 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9702 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9703 font table. */
9705 static void
9706 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9708 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9709 if (font->driver->check)
9710 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9713 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9716 /***********************************************************************
9717 Initialization
9718 ***********************************************************************/
9720 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9721 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9722 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9723 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9725 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9726 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9727 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9729 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9730 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9731 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9732 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9733 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9734 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9735 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9738 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9740 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9742 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9744 static int x_initialized;
9746 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9747 the screen number from the server number. */
9748 static int
9749 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9751 int seen_colon = 0;
9752 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9753 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9754 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9756 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9757 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9758 length_until_period++;
9760 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9761 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9762 name1 += 4;
9763 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9764 name2 += 4;
9765 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9766 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9767 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9768 name1 += system_name_length;
9769 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9770 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9771 name2 += system_name_length;
9772 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9773 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9774 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9775 name1 += length_until_period;
9776 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9777 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9778 name2 += length_until_period;
9780 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9782 if (*name1 == ':')
9783 seen_colon = 1;
9784 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9785 return 1;
9787 return (seen_colon
9788 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9789 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9792 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9793 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9794 to 5. */
9795 static void
9796 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9798 int nr = 0;
9799 int off = 0;
9801 while (!(mask & 1))
9803 off++;
9804 mask >>= 1;
9807 while (mask & 1)
9809 nr++;
9810 mask >>= 1;
9813 *offset = off;
9814 *bits = nr;
9817 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9818 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9820 bool
9821 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9823 Display *dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9824 return dpy ? (XCloseDisplay (dpy), 1) : 0;
9827 #ifdef USE_GTK
9828 static void
9829 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9830 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9832 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9833 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9835 #endif
9837 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9838 the structure that describes the open display.
9839 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9841 struct x_display_info *
9842 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9844 int connection;
9845 Display *dpy;
9846 struct terminal *terminal;
9847 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9848 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9849 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9850 ptrdiff_t lim;
9852 block_input ();
9854 if (!x_initialized)
9856 x_initialize ();
9857 ++x_initialized;
9860 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9861 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9863 #ifdef USE_GTK
9865 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9866 int argc;
9867 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9868 char **argv2 = argv;
9869 guint id;
9871 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9873 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9875 else
9877 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9878 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9880 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9881 argv[argc] = 0;
9883 argc = 0;
9884 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9886 if (! NILP (display_name))
9888 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9889 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9892 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9893 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9895 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9897 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
9898 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
9899 xputenv ("GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1");
9901 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
9902 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
9903 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
9904 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
9906 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
9907 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
9908 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
9910 /* gtk_init does set_locale. Fix locale before and after. */
9911 fixup_locale ();
9912 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
9913 fixup_locale ();
9915 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
9917 xg_initialize ();
9919 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
9921 #if ! GTK_CHECK_VERSION (2, 90, 0)
9922 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
9924 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
9925 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
9927 s = build_string (file);
9928 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
9930 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
9931 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
9933 #endif
9935 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
9936 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
9939 #else /* not USE_GTK */
9940 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9941 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
9942 errors with X11R5:
9943 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
9944 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
9945 So let's not use it until R6. */
9946 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9947 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
9948 #endif
9951 int argc = 0;
9952 char *argv[3];
9954 argv[0] = "";
9955 argc = 1;
9956 if (xrm_option)
9958 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
9959 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
9961 turn_on_atimers (0);
9962 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
9963 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
9964 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
9965 &argc, argv);
9966 turn_on_atimers (1);
9968 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
9969 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
9970 fixup_locale ();
9971 #endif
9974 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9975 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
9976 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
9977 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9978 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
9980 /* Detect failure. */
9981 if (dpy == 0)
9983 unblock_input ();
9984 return 0;
9987 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
9989 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
9990 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9992 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
9995 struct x_display_info *share;
9996 Lisp_Object tail;
9998 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
9999 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10000 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10001 SSDATA (display_name)))
10002 break;
10003 if (share)
10004 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10005 else
10007 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10008 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10009 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10011 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10012 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10013 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10014 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10015 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10017 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10019 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10021 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10022 list of terminals. */
10023 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10024 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10025 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10026 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10028 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10029 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10030 unblock_input ();
10031 kset_system_key_alist
10032 (terminal->kboard,
10033 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10034 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10035 block_input ();
10036 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10037 terminal_list = terminal;
10038 UNGCPRO;
10041 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10042 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10043 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10044 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10045 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10047 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10050 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10051 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10052 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10054 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10055 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10056 x_display_name_list);
10057 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10059 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10061 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10062 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10063 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10064 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10066 #if 0
10067 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10068 #endif /* ! 0 */
10070 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10071 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10072 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10073 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10074 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10075 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10076 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10078 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10079 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10081 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10082 #ifdef USE_GTK
10083 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10084 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10085 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10087 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10088 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10090 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10091 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10092 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10093 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10094 #else
10095 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10096 #endif
10097 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10098 all versions. */
10099 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10101 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10102 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10103 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10104 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10105 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10106 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10107 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10108 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10109 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10110 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10111 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10112 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10113 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10114 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10115 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10116 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10117 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10118 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10119 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10120 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10121 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10122 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10123 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10124 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10125 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10126 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10127 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10129 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10130 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10131 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10133 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10135 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10136 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10137 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10138 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10139 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10140 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10143 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10144 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10146 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10148 Lisp_Object value;
10149 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10150 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10151 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10152 Qnil, Qnil);
10153 if (STRINGP (value)
10154 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10155 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10156 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10159 else
10160 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10161 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10163 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10165 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10166 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10167 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10168 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10169 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10170 for example). */
10171 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10172 double d;
10173 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10174 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10176 #endif
10178 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10180 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10181 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10182 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10183 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10184 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10185 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10186 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10187 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10188 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10192 static const struct
10194 const char *name;
10195 int offset;
10196 } atom_refs[] = {
10197 #define ATOM_REFS_INIT(string, member) \
10198 { string, offsetof (struct x_display_info, member) },
10199 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_PROTOCOLS", Xatom_wm_protocols)
10200 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_TAKE_FOCUS", Xatom_wm_take_focus)
10201 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
10202 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_DELETE_WINDOW", Xatom_wm_delete_window)
10203 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CHANGE_STATE", Xatom_wm_change_state)
10204 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
10205 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_MOVED", Xatom_wm_window_moved)
10206 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("WM_CLIENT_LEADER", Xatom_wm_client_leader)
10207 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("Editres", Xatom_editres)
10208 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD", Xatom_CLIPBOARD)
10209 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TIMESTAMP", Xatom_TIMESTAMP)
10210 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TEXT", Xatom_TEXT)
10211 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("COMPOUND_TEXT", Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT)
10212 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("UTF8_STRING", Xatom_UTF8_STRING)
10213 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DELETE", Xatom_DELETE)
10214 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MULTIPLE", Xatom_MULTIPLE)
10215 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("INCR", Xatom_INCR)
10216 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_EMACS_TMP_", Xatom_EMACS_TMP)
10217 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("TARGETS", Xatom_TARGETS)
10218 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("NULL", Xatom_NULL)
10219 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM", Xatom_ATOM)
10220 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("ATOM_PAIR", Xatom_ATOM_PAIR)
10221 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER)
10222 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED_INFO", Xatom_XEMBED_INFO)
10223 /* For properties of font. */
10224 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PIXEL_SIZE", Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE)
10225 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("AVERAGE_WIDTH", Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH)
10226 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET)
10227 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE)
10228 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT)
10229 /* Ghostscript support. */
10230 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("DONE", Xatom_DONE)
10231 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("PAGE", Xatom_PAGE)
10232 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SCROLLBAR", Xatom_Scrollbar)
10233 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XEMBED", Xatom_XEMBED)
10234 /* EWMH */
10235 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE", Xatom_net_wm_state)
10236 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
10237 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10238 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
10239 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10240 Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
10241 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
10242 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
10243 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", Xatom_net_window_type)
10244 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10245 Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip)
10246 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_icon_name)
10247 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_NAME", Xatom_net_wm_name)
10248 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTED", Xatom_net_supported)
10249 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check)
10250 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity)
10251 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", Xatom_net_active_window)
10252 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", Xatom_net_frame_extents)
10253 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_CURRENT_DESKTOP", Xatom_net_current_desktop)
10254 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_NET_WORKAREA", Xatom_net_workarea)
10255 /* Session management */
10256 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("SM_CLIENT_ID", Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID)
10257 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", Xatom_xsettings_prop)
10258 ATOM_REFS_INIT ("MANAGER", Xatom_xsettings_mgr)
10261 int i;
10262 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10263 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10264 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10265 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10266 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10267 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10268 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10269 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10271 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10272 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10274 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10275 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10276 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10277 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10279 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10280 False, atoms_return);
10282 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10283 *(Atom *) ((char *) dpyinfo + atom_refs[i].offset) = atoms_return[i];
10285 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10286 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10288 xfree (atom_names);
10289 xfree (atoms_return);
10292 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10293 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10294 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10295 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10297 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10298 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10299 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10301 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10302 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10303 dpyinfo->gray
10304 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10305 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10306 1, 0, 1);
10308 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10309 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10310 #endif
10312 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10314 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10315 if (connection != 0)
10316 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10318 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10319 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10320 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10322 if (interrupt_input)
10323 init_sigio (connection);
10325 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10327 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10328 Font font;
10330 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10331 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10332 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10333 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10334 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10335 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10336 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10337 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10338 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10339 emacs_abort ();
10340 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10341 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10342 x_uncatch_errors ();
10344 #endif
10346 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10347 for debugging X code. */
10349 Lisp_Object value;
10350 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10351 build_string ("synchronous"),
10352 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10353 Qnil, Qnil);
10354 if (STRINGP (value)
10355 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10356 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10357 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10361 Lisp_Object value;
10362 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10363 build_string ("useXIM"),
10364 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10365 Qnil, Qnil);
10366 #ifdef USE_XIM
10367 if (STRINGP (value)
10368 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10369 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10370 use_xim = 0;
10371 #else
10372 if (STRINGP (value)
10373 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10374 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10375 use_xim = 1;
10376 #endif
10379 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10380 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10381 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10382 tty. */
10383 if (terminal->id == 1)
10384 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10385 #endif
10387 unblock_input ();
10389 return dpyinfo;
10392 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10393 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10395 static void
10396 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10398 struct terminal *t;
10400 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10401 X display. */
10402 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10403 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10405 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10406 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10407 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10408 x_session_close ();
10409 #endif
10410 delete_terminal (t);
10411 break;
10414 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10416 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10417 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10418 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10419 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10420 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10421 else
10423 Lisp_Object tail;
10425 tail = x_display_name_list;
10426 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10428 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10430 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10431 break;
10433 tail = XCDR (tail);
10437 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10438 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10440 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10441 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10442 else
10444 struct x_display_info *tail;
10446 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10447 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10448 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10451 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10452 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10453 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10454 xfree (dpyinfo);
10457 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10459 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10460 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10461 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10462 that slows us down. */
10464 static void
10465 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10467 block_input ();
10468 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10469 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10471 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10472 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10473 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10474 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10476 unblock_input ();
10479 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10480 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10481 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10482 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10483 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10484 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10485 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10487 void
10488 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10490 block_input ();
10491 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10493 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10494 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10495 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10497 unblock_input ();
10500 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10503 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10505 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10507 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10508 x_produce_glyphs,
10509 x_write_glyphs,
10510 x_insert_glyphs,
10511 x_clear_end_of_line,
10512 x_scroll_run,
10513 x_after_update_window_line,
10514 x_update_window_begin,
10515 x_update_window_end,
10516 x_cursor_to,
10517 x_flush,
10518 #ifdef XFlush
10519 x_flush,
10520 #else
10521 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10522 #endif
10523 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10524 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10525 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10526 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10527 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10528 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10529 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10530 x_draw_glyph_string,
10531 x_define_frame_cursor,
10532 x_clear_frame_area,
10533 x_draw_window_cursor,
10534 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10535 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10539 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10540 void
10541 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10543 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10545 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10546 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10547 if (!terminal->name)
10548 return;
10550 block_input ();
10551 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10552 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10553 X display. */
10554 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10555 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10556 #endif
10558 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10559 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10560 if (dpyinfo->display)
10562 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10563 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10565 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10566 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10567 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10568 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10570 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10571 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10572 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10573 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10574 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10575 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10576 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10577 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10578 leaks in other situations. */
10579 #if 0
10580 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10581 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10582 #else
10583 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10584 #endif
10585 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10586 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10587 closing all the displays. */
10588 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10589 #endif
10591 #ifdef USE_GTK
10592 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10593 #else
10594 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10595 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10596 #else
10597 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10598 #endif
10599 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10602 /* Mark as dead. */
10603 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10604 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10605 unblock_input ();
10608 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10609 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10611 static struct terminal *
10612 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10614 struct terminal *terminal;
10616 terminal = create_terminal ();
10618 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10619 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10620 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10622 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10624 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10625 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10626 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10627 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10628 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10629 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10630 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10631 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10632 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10633 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10634 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10635 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10636 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10637 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10638 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10639 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10640 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10641 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10642 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10643 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10645 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10646 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10648 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10649 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10650 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10651 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10652 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10653 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10654 off the bottom. */
10656 return terminal;
10659 void
10660 x_initialize (void)
10662 baud_rate = 19200;
10664 x_noop_count = 0;
10665 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10666 any_help_event_p = 0;
10667 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10669 #ifdef USE_GTK
10670 current_count = -1;
10671 #endif
10673 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10674 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10676 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10677 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10679 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10681 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10682 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10683 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10684 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10685 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10686 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10687 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10689 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10690 #endif
10692 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10693 #ifndef USE_GTK
10694 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10695 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10696 #endif
10697 #endif
10699 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10700 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10701 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10703 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10704 original error handler. */
10705 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10706 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10710 void
10711 syms_of_xterm (void)
10713 x_error_message = NULL;
10715 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10716 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10718 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10719 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10721 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10722 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10724 #ifdef USE_GTK
10725 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10726 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10728 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10729 #endif
10731 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10732 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10733 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10734 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10735 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10736 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10737 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10738 sizes. */);
10739 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10741 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10742 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10743 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10744 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10745 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10746 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10747 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10749 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10750 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10751 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10752 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10753 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10754 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10755 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10756 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10757 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10759 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10760 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10761 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10762 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10763 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10764 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10765 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10766 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10767 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10768 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10769 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10770 #elif USE_GTK
10771 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10772 #else
10773 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10774 #endif
10775 #else
10776 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10777 #endif
10779 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10780 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10782 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10783 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10784 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10785 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10786 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10787 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10788 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10789 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10790 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10792 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10793 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10794 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10795 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10796 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10797 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10799 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10800 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10801 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10802 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10803 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10804 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10806 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10807 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10808 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10809 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10810 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10811 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10813 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10814 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10815 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10816 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10817 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10818 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10820 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10821 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10822 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (hashtest_eql, make_number (900),
10823 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10824 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10825 Qnil);
10828 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */